blob: 987ea45c2354f72f472132ef4b601dfeca1a4136 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau446344c2021-08-28 13:46:11 +02007 2021/08/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
1038.2.5. Custom log format
1048.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
616quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
700When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
701double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
702and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
703a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
704a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
705the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
706regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
707around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
708more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200709
710
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007112.3. Environment variables
712--------------------------
713
714HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
715interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
716configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
717optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
718shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200719underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
720list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
721arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
722before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200723
724 Example:
725
726 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
727
728 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
729
730 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
731
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200732Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
733file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200734
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200735* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
736 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
737
738* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
739 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
740 directory.
741
742* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
743
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500744* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745 processes, separated by semicolons.
746
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500747* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200748 CLI, separated by semicolons.
749
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200750In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
751regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
752only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
753
754* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
755
756* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
757 starting at one.
758
759* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
760 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
761 first section.
762
763These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
764if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
765section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
766"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
767proxies.
768
769This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
770logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
771to name some config objects like servers for example.
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200774
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100775
7762.4. Conditional blocks
777-----------------------
778
779It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
780some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
781ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
782configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
783versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
784preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
785text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
786lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
787switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
788are defined to form conditional blocks:
789
790 - .if <condition>
791 - .elif <condition>
792 - .else
793 - .endif
794
795The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
796as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
797matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
798there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
799only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
800".elif" of a block.
801
802Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
803ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
804as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
805
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200806Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
807See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
808
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200809The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
810expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100811
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100812 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
813 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200814 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200815 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530816 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
817 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200818 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
819 from left to right until one returns false
820 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
821 from right to left until one returns true
822
823Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
824operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825
826The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
827
828 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
829 exists, regardless of its contents
830
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200831 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
832 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
833 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
834
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200835 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
836 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
837
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200838 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
839 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
840 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
841 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
842
843 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
844 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
845 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
846 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100849
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200850 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
851 listen mwcli_px
852 bind :1111
853 ...
854 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100855
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200856 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
857 bind :80
858 .endif
859
860 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200863 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200864 .endif
865
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200866 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200867 bind :443 ssl crt ...
868 .endif
869
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200870 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
871 profiling.memory on
872 .endif
873
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200874 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
875 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
876 .endif
877
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200878Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100879
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200880 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100881 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
882 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
883 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
884
885Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
886"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
887fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
888provide advice to the user.
889
890Example:
891
892 .if "${A}"
893 .if "${B}"
894 .notice "A=1, B=1"
895 .elif "${C}"
896 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
897 .elif "${D}"
898 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
899 .else
900 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
901 .endif
902 .else
903 .notice "A=0"
904 .endif
905
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200906 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
907 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
908
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100909
9102.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200911----------------
912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
915otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
916numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
917for every keyword. Supported units are :
918
919 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
920 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
921 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
922 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
923 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
924 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
925
926
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009272.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200928-------------
929
930 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
931 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
932 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
933 global
934 daemon
935 maxconn 256
936
937 defaults
938 mode http
939 timeout connect 5000ms
940 timeout client 50000ms
941 timeout server 50000ms
942
943 frontend http-in
944 bind *:80
945 default_backend servers
946
947 backend servers
948 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
949
950
951 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
952 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
953 global
954 daemon
955 maxconn 256
956
957 defaults
958 mode http
959 timeout connect 5000ms
960 timeout client 50000ms
961 timeout server 50000ms
962
963 listen http-in
964 bind *:80
965 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
966
967
968Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
969
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100970 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200971
972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974--------------------
975
976Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
977are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
978of them have command-line equivalents.
979
980The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
981
982 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200983 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200985 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200988 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200989 - description
990 - deviceatlas-json-file
991 - deviceatlas-log-level
992 - deviceatlas-separator
993 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200994 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900995 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996 - gid
997 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100998 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200999 - h1-case-adjust
1000 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001001 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001002 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001003 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001004 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001005 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001007 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001008 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001009 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001010 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001011 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001012 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001013 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001014 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001015 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001017 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001018 - presetenv
1019 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020 - uid
1021 - ulimit-n
1022 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001023 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001024 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001025 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001026 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001027 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001028 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001029 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - ssl-default-bind-options
1031 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001032 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - ssl-default-server-options
1034 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001035 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001036 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001037 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001038 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001039 - 51degrees-data-file
1040 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001041 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001042 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001043 - wurfl-data-file
1044 - wurfl-information-list
1045 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001046 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001047 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001048
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001050 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001051 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001053 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001054 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001055 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001056 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001058 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001059 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001060 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - noepoll
1062 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001063 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001065 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001066 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001067 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001068 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001069 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001070 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001071 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001072 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001073 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - tune.buffers.limit
1075 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001076 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001077 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001078 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001079 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001080 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001081 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001082 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001083 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001084 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001085 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001086 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001087 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001088 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001089 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1090 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001091 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001092 - tune.maxaccept
1093 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001094 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001095 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001096 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001097 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1098 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001099 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1100 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001101 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001102 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001103 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001104 - tune.sndbuf.client
1105 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001106 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001107 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001108 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001109 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001110 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001111 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001112 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001113 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1114 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001115 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001116 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001117 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1118 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1119 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001120 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1121 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001122
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001125 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126
1127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011283.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001129------------------------------------
1130
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001131ca-base <dir>
1132 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001133 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1134 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1135 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001136
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137chroot <jail dir>
1138 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1139 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1140 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1141 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1142 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001143 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001144
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001145cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001146 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001147 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1148 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1149 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1150 set. These sets have the format
1151
1152 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1153
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001154 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1155 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001156 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001157 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001158 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1159 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001160 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1161 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1162 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1163 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1164 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1165 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1166 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1167 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1168 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1169 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001170
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001171 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1172 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1173 on the machine's word size.
1174
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001175 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001176 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1177 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1178 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1179 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1180 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1181 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001182
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001183 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1184 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1185 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1186 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001187
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001188 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001189 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1190 # first 4 CPUs
1191
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001192 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1193 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001194 # word size.
1195
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001196 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1197 # and so on.
1198 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1199 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1200 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1201
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001202 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1203 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1204 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1205 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001206
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001207 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1208 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1209 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001210
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001211crt-base <dir>
1212 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001213 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1214 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001215
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001216daemon
1217 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1218 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001219 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1220 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001221
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001222default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001223 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001224 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1225 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1226 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1227 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1228 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1229 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1230 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1231 not start with a slash ('/'):
1232 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1233 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1234
1235 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1236 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1237 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1238 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1239 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1240 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1241 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1242 each of them.
1243
1244 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1245 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1246 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1247 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1248 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1249 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1250 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1251 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1252
1253 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1254 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001255 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001256 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1257 made easily relocatable.
1258
1259 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1260 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1261 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1262 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1263 consistent across all configuration files.
1264
1265 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1266 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1267 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1268 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1269 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1270 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1271 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1272 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1273
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001274deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1275 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001277
1278deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001279 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001280 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1281
1282deviceatlas-separator <char>
1283 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1284 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1285
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001286deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001287 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1288 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1289 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001290
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001291expose-experimental-directives
1292 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1293 the config file will be rejected.
1294
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001295external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001296 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1297 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001298 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1299 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1300 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1301 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1302 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001303
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001304gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001305 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1307 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001308 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001309 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001310 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001311
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001312group <group name>
1313 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1314 See also "gid" and "user".
1315
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001316hard-stop-after <time>
1317 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1318
1319 Arguments :
1320 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1321 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1322 SIGUSR1 signal.
1323
1324 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1325 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1326 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1327
1328 Example:
1329 global
1330 hard-stop-after 30s
1331
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001332h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1333 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1334 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1335 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1336 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001337 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001338 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1339 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1340 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1341 specified in a proxy.
1342
1343 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1344 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1345 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1346 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1347 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1348 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1349 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1350
1351 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1352 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1353 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1354 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1355 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1356
1357 Example:
1358 global
1359 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1360
1361 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1362 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1363
1364h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1365 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1366 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1367 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1368 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1369 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1370 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1371 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1372 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1373
1374 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1375 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1376 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1377
1378 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1379 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1380
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001381insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001382 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001383 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1384 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1385 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1386 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1387 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1388 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1389 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001390 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001391 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1392 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1393 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1394 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1395 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1396 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1397 disable it.
1398
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001399insecure-setuid-wanted
1400 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1401 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1402 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1403 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001404 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001405 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001406 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001407 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1408 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001409 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001410 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1411 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1412 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1413 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1414
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001415issuers-chain-path <dir>
1416 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1417 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1418 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001419 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001420 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1421 "issuers-chain-path".
1422 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1423 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1424 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1425 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1426 will share the chain in memory.
1427
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001428h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1429 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1430 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1431 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1432 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1433 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1434 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1435 the keyword with "no'.
1436
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001437localpeer <name>
1438 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1439 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1440 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1441 the configuration parsing.
1442
1443 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1444 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1445
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001446log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001447 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001448 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001449 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001450 configured with "log global".
1451
1452 <address> can be one of:
1453
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001454 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001455 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1456 port).
1457
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001458 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1459 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1460 port).
1461
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001462 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001463 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1464 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001465 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001466
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001467 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1468 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1469 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1470 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1471 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1472 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1473 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1474 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1475 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1476 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001477 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001478 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1479 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1480 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001481 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1482 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001483
1484 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1485 "fd@2", see above.
1486
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001487 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1488 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1489 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1490 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1491 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1492
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001493 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1494 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001495
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001496 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1497 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1498 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1499 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1500 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1501 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1502 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1503 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1504 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1505 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1507 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001508
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001509 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1510 one of the following :
1511
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001512 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1513 field is stripped. This is the default.
1514 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1515 rfc3164.
1516
1517 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001518 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1519
1520 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1521 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1522
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001523 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1524 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1525 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1526 designed to be used with a local log server.
1527
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001528 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1529 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1530 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1531 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1532 logger consumes.
1533
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001534 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1535 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1536 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1537 used with a local log server.
1538
1539 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1540 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1541 designed to be used with a local log server.
1542
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001543 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1544 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1545 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1546 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1547
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001548 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1549 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1550 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1551 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1552 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1553
1554 <sample_size>
1555 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1556 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1557 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1558 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1559 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1560
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001561 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001562
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001563 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1564 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1565 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1566
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001567 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1568 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1569 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1570 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001571
1572 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001573 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1574 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1575 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1576 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1577 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1578 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001579
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001580 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001582log-send-hostname [<string>]
1583 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1584 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1585 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1586 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1587 the logs.
1588
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001589log-tag <string>
1590 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1591 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1592 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001593 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001594
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001595lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001596 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1597 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1598 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1599 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1600 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1601 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001602 used multiple times.
1603
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001604lua-load-per-thread <file>
1605 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1606 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1607 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1608 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1609 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1610 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1611 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1612 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1613 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1614 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1615 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1616 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1617 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1618 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1619 times.
1620
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001621lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1622 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1623 variable.
1624 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1625 to "path".
1626
1627 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1628 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1629 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1630 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1631 will be checked earlier.
1632
1633 As an example by specifying the following path:
1634
1635 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1636 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1637
1638 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1639 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1640 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1641 paths if that does not exist either.
1642
1643 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1644 documentation.
1645
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001646master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001647 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1648 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1649 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001650 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001651 or daemon mode.
1652
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001653 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1654 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1655 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1656 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1657 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001658
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001659 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001660
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001661mworker-max-reloads <number>
1662 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001663 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001664 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1665 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1666 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1667
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001668nbthread <number>
1669 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001670 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1671 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1672 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1673 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1674 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1675 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1676 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001677
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001678numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001679 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001680 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1681 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1682 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1683 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1684 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1685 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1686 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1687 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001689pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001690 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1691 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1692 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1693 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001694
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001695pp2-never-send-local
1696 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1697 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1698 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1699 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1700 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1701 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1702 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1703 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1704 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1705 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1706 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1707
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001708presetenv <name> <value>
1709 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1710 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1711 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1712 and "unsetenv".
1713
1714resetenv [<name> ...]
1715 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1716 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1717 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1718 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1719 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1720 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1721 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1722 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1723
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001724stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001725 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1726 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1727 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001728
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001729server-state-base <directory>
1730 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001731 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1732 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001733
1734server-state-file <file>
1735 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1736 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1737 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1738 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1739 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1740 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1741 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1742 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001743 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1744 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001745
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001746set-var <var-name> <expr>
1747 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1748 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1749 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1750 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1751 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1752 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1753 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1754 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1755 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1756
1757 Example:
1758 global
1759 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1760 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1761 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1762
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001763setenv <name> <value>
1764 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1765 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1766 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1767 and "unsetenv".
1768
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001769set-dumpable
1770 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001771 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1772 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1773 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1774 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1775 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1776 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1777 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1778 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1779 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1780 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1781 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1782 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1783 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1784 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1785 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001786 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001787 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001788
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001789ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1791 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001792 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001793 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001794 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1795 information and recommendations see e.g.
1796 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1797 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1798 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1799 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001800
1801ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1803 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1804 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1805 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1806 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001807 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1808 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1809 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001810 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001811
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001812ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1814 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1815 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1816 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1817 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1818
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001819ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1821 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1822 keyword to see available options.
1823
1824 Example:
1825 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001826 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001827
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001828ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1830 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001831 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001832 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001833 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1834 information and recommendations see e.g.
1835 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1836 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1837 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1838 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1839 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001840
1841ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1843 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1844 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1845 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1846 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001847 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1848 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1849 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1850 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001851
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001852ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1854 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1855 keyword to see available options.
1856
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001857ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1859 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1860 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001862 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001863 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1864 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1865 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1866 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001867 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1868 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1869 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1870
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001871ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1872 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1873 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001874 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001875 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001876 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1877
1878 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001879
1880 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1881 and won't try to remove them.
1882
1883 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1884
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001885ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001886 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001887 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1888 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1889 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001890
1891 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1892 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1893 optimize the startup time.
1894
1895 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1896 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1897 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1898
1899 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001900 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001901
1902 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001903 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1904 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001905
1906 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1907 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1908 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1909 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1910 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001911 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001912
1913 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001914 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001915 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1916 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1917 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1918 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1919 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001920 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001921
1922 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1923
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001924 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001925 a cert bundle.
1926
1927 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1928 separately in several "crt".
1929
1930 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1931 since files are loading separately.
1932
1933 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1934 required to commit them.
1935
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001936 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001937 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001938
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001939 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1940 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1941 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001942
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001943 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1944 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1945 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001946
1947 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001948 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1949 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001950
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001951 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1952 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1953
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001954 The default behavior is "all".
1955
1956 Example:
1957 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1958 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1959 ssl-load-extra-files none
1960
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001961 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1962 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001963
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001964ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1965 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1966 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1967 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1968
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001969ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001970 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001971 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1972 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1973 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1974 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1975 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1976 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001977 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001978
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001979stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1980 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1981 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1982 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001983 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001984 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001985
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001986 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1987 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1988 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001989
1990stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1991 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1992 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001993 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001994
1995stats maxconn <connections>
1996 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1997 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1998
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001999uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002000 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002001 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2002 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2003 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2004
2005ulimit-n <number>
2006 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2007 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2008 option.
2009
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002010 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2011 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2012 manually specify this value.
2013
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002014unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2015 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2016
2017 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2018 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2019 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2020 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2021 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002022 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002023 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2024 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2025 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2026 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2027
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002028unsetenv [<name> ...]
2029 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2030 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2031 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2032 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2033 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2034 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2035 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037user <user name>
2038 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2039 See also "uid" and "group".
2040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002041node <name>
2042 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2043
2044 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2045 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2046 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2047 traffic.
2048
2049description <text>
2050 Add a text that describes the instance.
2051
2052 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2053 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2054 "<" and ">" characters.
2055
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100205651degrees-data-file <file path>
2057 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002058 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002059
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002060 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002061 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2062
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000206351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002064 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2065 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2066 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2067
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002068 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002069 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2070
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200207151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002072 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2073 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2074
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002075 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002076 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2077
207851degrees-cache-size <number>
2079 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2080 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2081 By default, this cache is disabled.
2082
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002084 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2085
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002086wurfl-data-file <file path>
2087 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2088 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2089
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002090 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002091 with USE_WURFL=1.
2092
2093wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2094 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2095 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2096 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2097
2098 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2099
2100 Valid WURFL properties are:
2101 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2102
2103 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2104 device.
2105
2106 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2107 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2108
2109 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2110 particular web request.
2111
2112 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2113 used Libwurfl API version.
2114
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002115 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2116 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2117
2118 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2119 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2120
2121 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002123 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002124 with USE_WURFL=1.
2125
2126wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2127 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2128 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002130 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002131 with USE_WURFL=1.
2132
2133wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2134 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2135 thus before the chroot.
2136
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002137 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002138 with USE_WURFL=1.
2139
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002140wurfl-cache-size <size>
2141 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2142 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002143 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002144 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002146 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002147 with USE_WURFL=1.
2148
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002149strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002150 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002151 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2152 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002153 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002154 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021563.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002157-----------------------
2158
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002159busy-polling
2160 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2161 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2162 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2163 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2164 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2165 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2166 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2167 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2168 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2169 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2170 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2171 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2172 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2173 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2174 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2175 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2176 "poll" pollers.
2177
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002178 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2179 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2180 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2181
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002182max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002183 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002184 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2185 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2186 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2187 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2188 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2189 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2190 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2191
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002192maxconn <number>
2193 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2194 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2195 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002196 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2197 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2198 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2199 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002200 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2201 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2202 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2203 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2204 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2205 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002206
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002207maxconnrate <number>
2208 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2209 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2210 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2211 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2212 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2213 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2214 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2215 fairness.
2216
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002217maxcomprate <number>
2218 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002219 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002220 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2221 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2222 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002223 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002224 default value.
2225
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002226maxcompcpuusage <number>
2227 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2228 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2229 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002230 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2231 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2232 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2233 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002234
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002235maxpipes <number>
2236 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2237 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2238 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2239 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2240 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2241 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2242
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002243maxsessrate <number>
2244 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2245 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2246 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2247 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2248 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2249 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2250 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2251 fairness.
2252
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002253maxsslconn <number>
2254 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2255 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2256 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2257 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2258 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2259 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2260 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002261 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2262 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2263 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2264 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002265 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002266 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2267 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002268
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002269maxsslrate <number>
2270 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2271 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2272 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2273 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2274 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2275 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2276 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2277 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2278 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2279 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2280
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002281maxzlibmem <number>
2282 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2283 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2284 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002285 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2286 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2287 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2288
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002289noepoll
2290 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2291 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002292 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002293
2294nokqueue
2295 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2296 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2297 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2298
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002299noevports
2300 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2301 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2302 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2303 also "nopoll".
2304
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002305nopoll
2306 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2307 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002309 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2310 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002312nosplice
2313 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002314 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002315 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002316 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002317 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2318 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2319 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2320 "option splice-response".
2321
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002322nogetaddrinfo
2323 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2324 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2325
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002326noreuseport
2327 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2328 command line argument "-dR".
2329
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002330profiling.memory { on | off }
2331 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2332 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2333 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2334 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2335 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2336 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2337 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2338 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2339 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2340
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002341profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2342 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2343 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2344 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2345 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002346 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002347 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2348 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2349 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2350 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2351
2352 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2353 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2354 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2355 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2356 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002357 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2358 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2359 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2360 CLI.
2361
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002362spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002363 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2364 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2365 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2366 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2367 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2368 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002369
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002370ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002371 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002372 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002373 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002374 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002375 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2376 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2377 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002378 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2379 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002380 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2381 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2382 openssl configuration file uses:
2383 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2384
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002385ssl-mode-async
2386 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002387 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002388 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2389 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002390 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002391 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002392 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002393
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002394tune.buffers.limit <number>
2395 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2396 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2397 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2398 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2399 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002400 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002401 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2402 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2403 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2404 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2405 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2406 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2407 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2408 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002409 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002410
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002411tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2412 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2413 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2414 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002415 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002416
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002417tune.bufsize <number>
2418 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2419 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2420 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2421 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2422 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2423 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2424 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002425 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2426 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002427 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002428 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002429 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002430 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2431 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002432
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002433tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2434 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2435 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2436 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2437 this value. The default value is 1.
2438
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002439tune.fail-alloc
2440 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2441 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2442 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2443 gracefully.
2444
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002445tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2446 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2447 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2448 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2449 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2450 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2451
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002452tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2453 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2454 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2455 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2456 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2457 change it.
2458
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002459tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2460 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002461 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002462 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002463 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2464 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2465 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2466 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2467 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2468
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002469tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2470 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2471 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2472 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2473 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2474 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002475 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002476 recommended not to change this value.
2477
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002478tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002479 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002480 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002481 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002482 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2483 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2484 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2485 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2486
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002487tune.http.cookielen <number>
2488 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2489 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2490 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2491 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2492 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2493 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2494 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2495 to change this value.
2496
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002497tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002498 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2499 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002500 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002501 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002502 configuration directives too.
2503 The default value is 1024.
2504
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002505tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2506 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2507 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2508 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2509 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2510 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2511 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002512 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2513 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2514 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002515
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002516tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2517 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2518 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2519 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2520 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2521 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2522 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002523 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2524 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2525 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2526 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2527 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002528
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002529tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002530 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002531 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2532 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2533 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2534 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002535 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002536 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002537 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002538 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2539
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002540tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2541 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2542 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2543 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2544 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2545 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2546 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2547 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2548 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2549 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2550
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002551tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2552 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002553 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002554 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2555 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002557 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2558 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2559
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002560tune.lua.maxmem
2561 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2562 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2563 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2564 memory.
2565
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002566tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2567 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002568 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2569 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002570 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002571
2572tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2573 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2574 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2575 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2576 check servers.
2577
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002578tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2579 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2580 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2581 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002582 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002583
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002584tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002585 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2586 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002587 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2588 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2589 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2590 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2591 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2592 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2593 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2594 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2595 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002596
2597tune.maxpollevents <number>
2598 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2599 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2600 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2601 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2602 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2603
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002604tune.maxrewrite <number>
2605 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2606 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2607 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2608 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2609 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2610 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2611 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2612 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2613 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2614 bufsize.
2615
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002616tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2617 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2618 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2619 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2620 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2621 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2622 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2623 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2624 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2625 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002626 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2627 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002628 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2629 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2630 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2631 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2632 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2633 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2634 setting this parameter to 0.
2635
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002636tune.pipesize <number>
2637 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2638 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2639 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2640 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2641 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2642 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2643
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002644tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2645 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002646 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002647 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2648 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2649 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2650 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002651 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002652
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002653tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2654 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002655 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002656 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2657 default is 20.
2658
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002659tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2660tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2661 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2662 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2663 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002664 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002665 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002666 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2667 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2668
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002669tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002670 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002671 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2672 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2673 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2674 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2675
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002676tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002677 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002678 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2679 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2680 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2681 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2682 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2683 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2684 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002685
2686tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2687 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002688 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002689 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2690 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2691 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2692 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2693 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2694 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2695 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002696
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002697tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2698tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2699 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2700 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2701 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002702 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002703 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002704 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2705 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2706 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2707 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002708 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002709
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002710tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002711 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002712 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2713 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2714 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2715 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2716 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2717 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2718 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2719 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2720 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002721 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2722 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002723
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002724tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002725 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002726 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2727 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2728 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2729 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2730 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2731
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002732tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2733 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2734 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2735 performances. This is disabled by default.
2736
2737 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2738 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2739
2740 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2741
2742 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2743
2744 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2745
2746 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2747 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2748 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2749
2750 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2751 converted.
2752
2753 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2754 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2755 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2756 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2757 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2758 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2759 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002760 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2761 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002762
2763 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2764
2765 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2766 only need this line:
2767
2768 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2769
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002770tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2771 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002772 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002773 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2774 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2775 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2776 being used for too long.
2777
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002778tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2779 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2780 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2781 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2782 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2783 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2784 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2785 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2786 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2787 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2788 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002789 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002790 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002791
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002792tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2793 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2794 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2795 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2796 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002797 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002798 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2799 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002800 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2801 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002802
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002803tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2804 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2805 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2806 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2807 1000 entries.
2808
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02002809tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
2810tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002811 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2812 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2813 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2814 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002815
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002816tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002817tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002818tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2819tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2820tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002821 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2822 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2823 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2824 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2825 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2826 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2827 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2828 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002829
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002830 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2831 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2832 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2833 all available space is consumed.
2834 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2835 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2836 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002837
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002838tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2839 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002840 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002841 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002842 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002843 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2844
2845tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2846 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2847 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002848 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2849 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028513.3. Debugging
2852--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002853
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002854quiet
2855 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2856 line argument "-q".
2857
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002858zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002859 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002860 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2861 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2862 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2863 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2864 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2865
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028673.4. Userlists
2868--------------
2869It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2870http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2871it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2872
2873userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002874 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002875 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2876
2877group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002878 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002879 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2880 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2881
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002882user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2883 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002884 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2885 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002886 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2887 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2888 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2889 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002890
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002891 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2892 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2893 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2894 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2895 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2896 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2897 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002898 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002899 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002900
2901 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002902 userlist L1
2903 group G1 users tiger,scott
2904 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002905
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002906 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2907 user scott insecure-password elgato
2908 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002909
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002910 userlist L2
2911 group G1
2912 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002913
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002914 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2915 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2916 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917
2918 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002919
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002920
29213.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002922----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002923It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002924several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002925instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2926values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2927automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2928In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2929using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2930tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2931reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2932Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2933that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2934each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002935
2936peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002938 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2939
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002940bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2941 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2942 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2943
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002944disabled
2945 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2946 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2947 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2948
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002949default-bind [param*]
2950 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2951
2952default-server [param*]
2953 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2954
2955 Arguments:
2956 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2957 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2958 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2959 details.
2960
2961
2962 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2963
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002964enable
2965 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2966
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002967log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002968 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2969 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2970 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2971 more details.
2972
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002973peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002974 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2975 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002976 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002977 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002978 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2979 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2980 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981
2982 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2983 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2984
2985 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002986 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2987 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2988 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002989
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002990 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2991 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002992
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002993 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2994 "server" keyword explanation below).
2995
2996server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002997 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002998 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2999 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3000 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3001 of this "peers" section).
3002 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3003
3004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003005 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003006 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003007 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003008 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3009 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3010 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003011
3012 backend mybackend
3013 mode tcp
3014 balance roundrobin
3015 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3016 stick on src
3017
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003018 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3019 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003020
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003021 Example:
3022 peers mypeers
3023 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3024 default-server ssl verify none
3025 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3026 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003027
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003028
3029table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3030 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3031
3032 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3033 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003034 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003035 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3036 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3037 "stick-table" keyword).
3038
3039 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3040 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3041 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3042 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3043 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3044 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3045 of the stick-table name as follows:
3046
3047 peers mypeers
3048 peer A ...
3049 peer B ...
3050 table t1 ...
3051
3052 frontend fe1
3053 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3054
3055 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3056 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3057
3058 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3059 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3060 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3061 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3062 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3063 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3064 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3065
3066 peers mypeers
3067 peer A ...
3068 peer B ...
3069 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3070
3071 backend t1
3072 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3073
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003074 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003075 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3076 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3077
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030783.6. Mailers
3079------------
3080It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3081If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3082in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3083
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003084mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003085 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3086 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3087
3088mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3089 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3090
3091 Example:
3092 mailers mymailers
3093 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3094 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3095
3096 backend mybackend
3097 mode tcp
3098 balance roundrobin
3099
3100 email-alert mailers mymailers
3101 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3102 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3103
3104 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3105 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3106
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003107timeout mail <time>
3108 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3109 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3110 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3111 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3112
3113 Example:
3114 mailers mymailers
3115 timeout mail 20s
3116 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003117
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031183.7. Programs
3119-------------
3120In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3121master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3122managed the same way as the workers.
3123
3124During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3125sequence as a worker:
3126
3127 - the master is re-executed
3128 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3129 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3130 instance of the program
3131
3132During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3133
3134program <name>
3135 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3136 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3137 the management guide).
3138
3139command <command> [arguments*]
3140 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3141 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3142 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3143 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3144
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003145user <user name>
3146 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3147 See also "group".
3148
3149group <group name>
3150 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3151 See also "user".
3152
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003153option start-on-reload
3154no option start-on-reload
3155 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3156 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3157 program section.
3158
3159
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031603.8. HTTP-errors
3161----------------
3162
3163It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3164imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3165several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3166
3167http-errors <name>
3168 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3169 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3170
3171errorfile <code> <file>
3172 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3173
3174 Arguments :
3175 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003176 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003177 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003178
3179 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3180 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3181 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3182 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3183 before any chroot is performed.
3184
3185 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3186
3187 Example:
3188 http-errors website-1
3189 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3190 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3191 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3192
3193 http-errors website-2
3194 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3195 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3196 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3197
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031983.9. Rings
3199----------
3200
3201It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3202servers or traces.
3203
3204ring <ringname>
3205 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3206
3207description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003208 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003209 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3210
3211format <format>
3212 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3213
3214 Arguments:
3215 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3216 one of the following :
3217
3218 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3219 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3220 designed to be used with a local log server.
3221
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003222 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3223 field is stripped. This is the default.
3224 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3225 rfc3164.
3226
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003227 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3228 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3229 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3230 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3231 is the default.
3232
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003233 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003234 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3235
3236 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3237 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3238
3239 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3240 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3241 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3242 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3243 logger consumes.
3244
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003245 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3246 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3247 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3248 with a local log server.
3249
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003250 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3251 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3252 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3253 used with a local log server.
3254
3255maxlen <length>
3256 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3257 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3258 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3259
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003260server <name> <address> [param*]
3261 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3262 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3263 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3264 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3265 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3266 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3267 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3268 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3269 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003270 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3271 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003272
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003273size <size>
3274 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3275 set to BUFSIZE.
3276
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003277timeout connect <timeout>
3278 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3279
3280 Arguments :
3281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3283 as explained at the top of this document.
3284
3285timeout server <timeout>
3286 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3287
3288 Arguments :
3289 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3290 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3291 as explained at the top of this document.
3292
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003293 Example:
3294 global
3295 log ring@myring local7
3296
3297 ring myring
3298 description "My local buffer"
3299 format rfc3164
3300 maxlen 1200
3301 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003302 timeout connect 5s
3303 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003304 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003305
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033063.10. Log forwarding
3307-------------------
3308
3309It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003310HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003311
3312log-forward <name>
3313 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3314
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003315backlog <conns>
3316 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3317 on connections accept.
3318
3319bind <addr> [param*]
3320 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003321 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3322 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3323 syslog protocol over TCP.
3324 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003325 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3326
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003327dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003328 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3329 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3330 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3331 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003332 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003333
3334log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003335log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003336 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3337 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3338 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003339 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003340 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3341 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3342 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003343 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003344
3345 Example:
3346 global
3347 log stderr format iso local7
3348
3349 ring myring
3350 description "My local buffer"
3351 format rfc5424
3352 maxlen 1200
3353 size 32764
3354 timeout connect 5s
3355 timeout server 10s
3356 # syslog tcp server
3357 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3358
3359 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003360 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3361 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003362 # all messages on stderr
3363 log global
3364 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3365 log ring@myring local0
3366 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3367 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3368 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3369 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3370 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003371
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003372maxconn <conns>
3373 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3374 10 is the default.
3375
3376timeout client <timeout>
3377 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033794. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003380----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003381
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003382Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003383 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3384 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3385 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3386 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003387
3388A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3389connections.
3390
3391A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3392to forward incoming connections.
3393
3394A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3395parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3396
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003397A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3398ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3399sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3400the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3401explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3402from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3403"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3404for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3405to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3406optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3407are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3408any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3409names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3410that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3411duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3412names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3413
3414Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3415settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3416of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3417profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3418timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3421'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3422case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3423
3424Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3425logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3426proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3427However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3428name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3429
3430Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3431and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003432bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3434modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3435arbitrary criteria.
3436
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003437In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3438a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003439the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003440
3441 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3442 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3443 between responses and new requests.
3444
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003445 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3446 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3447 client-facing connection remains open.
3448
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003449 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3450 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003451
3452The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3453frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3454following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003455weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003456
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003457 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003458
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003459 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3460 ----+-----+-----+----
3461 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3462 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003463 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3464 ----+-----+-----+----
3465 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003466
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003467It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003468only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3469within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003470as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003471content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003472and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3473possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003474
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003475There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003476first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003477processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003478second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003479protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3480is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3481new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003482to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003483process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3484already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3485HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3486evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3487one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3488
3489There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3490performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3491tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3492preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3493analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3494HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3495header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3496mitigate this drawback.
3497
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003498There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003499method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3500set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3501in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3502is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3503to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3504above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3505to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3506"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3507frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3508frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3509as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3510upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3511on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3512the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3513upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3514frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3515remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035174.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3518--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003520The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3521limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3522they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3523limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003524marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003525option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003526and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3527with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3528specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003530
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003531 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3532------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3533acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003534backlog X X X -
3535balance X - X X
3536bind - X X -
3537bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003538capture cookie - X X -
3539capture request header - X X -
3540capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003541clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3542clitcpka-idle X X X -
3543clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003544compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003546declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003547default-server X - X X
3548default_backend X X X -
3549description - X X X
3550disabled X X X X
3551dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003552email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003553email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003554email-alert mailers X X X X
3555email-alert myhostname X X X X
3556email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003557enabled X X X X
3558errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003559errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003560errorloc X X X X
3561errorloc302 X X X X
3562-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3563errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003564error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003565force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003566filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003567fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003568hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003569http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003570http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003571http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003572http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003573http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003574http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003575http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003576http-check set-var X - X X
3577http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003578http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003579http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003580http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003581http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003582http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003583id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003584ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003585load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003586log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003587log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003588log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003589log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003590max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003591maxconn X X X -
3592mode X X X X
3593monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594monitor-uri X X X -
3595option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3596option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3597option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3598option allbackups (*) X - X X
3599option checkcache (*) X - X X
3600option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3601option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003602option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003603option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3604option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3606option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003607option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3608option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003609option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003610option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003611option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003612option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003613option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3615option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3616option httpchk X - X X
3617option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003618option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003619option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003620option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003621option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003622option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3624option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3625option logasap (*) X X X -
3626option mysql-check X - X X
3627option nolinger (*) X X X X
3628option originalto X X X X
3629option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003630option pgsql-check X - X X
3631option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003632option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003633option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003634option smtpchk X - X X
3635option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3636option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3637option splice-request (*) X X X X
3638option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003639option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003640option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3641option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3642-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003643option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003644option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3645option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3646option tcpka X X X X
3647option tcplog X X X X
3648option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003649external-check command X - X X
3650external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003651persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3652rate-limit sessions X X X -
3653redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003655retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003656retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003657server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003658server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003659server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003661srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3662srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3663srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003664stats admin - X X X
3665stats auth X X X X
3666stats enable X X X X
3667stats hide-version X X X X
3668stats http-request - X X X
3669stats realm X X X X
3670stats refresh X X X X
3671stats scope X X X X
3672stats show-desc X X X X
3673stats show-legends X X X X
3674stats show-node X X X X
3675stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003676-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3677stick match - - X X
3678stick on - - X X
3679stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003680stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003681stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003682tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003683tcp-check connect X - X X
3684tcp-check expect X - X X
3685tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003686tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003687tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003688tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003689tcp-check set-var X - X X
3690tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003691tcp-request connection - X X -
3692tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003693tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003694tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003695tcp-response content - - X X
3696tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003697timeout check X - X X
3698timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003699timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003700timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3702timeout http-request X X X X
3703timeout queue X - X X
3704timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003705timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003706timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003707timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003708transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003709unique-id-format X X X -
3710unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003711use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003712use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003713use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003714------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3715 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3719---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003720
3721This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3722
3723
3724acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3725 Declare or complete an access list.
3726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 no | yes | yes | yes
3728 Example:
3729 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3730 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3731 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003733 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003734
3735
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003736backlog <conns>
3737 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | no
3740 Arguments :
3741 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3742 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003743 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003744
3745 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3746 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3747 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3748 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3749 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3750 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3751 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3752 backlog parameter.
3753
3754 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3755 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3756 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3757
3758 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3759
3760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003761balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003762balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003763 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | no | yes | yes
3766 Arguments :
3767 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3768 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3769 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3770 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3771
3772 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3773 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3774 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3775 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003776 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003777 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003778 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3779 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3780 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3781 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3782 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3783 it, so that you don't worry.
3784
3785 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3786 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3787 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3788 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3789 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3790 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3791 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3792 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003793
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003794 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3795 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3796 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3797 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3798 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3799 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3800 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003801 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3802 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3803 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003804
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003805 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003806 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003807 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3808 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003809 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003810 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3811 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3812 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3813 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3814 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003815 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3816 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3817 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3818 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3819 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3820 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003822 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3823 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3824 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3825 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3826 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3827 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3828 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3829 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003830 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003831 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003832 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3833 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3834 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003836 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3837 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3838 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3839 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3840 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3841 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3842 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3843 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3844 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3845 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3846 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3847 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003848
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003849 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003850 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3851 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3852 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3853 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3854 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3855 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3856 URIs start with a leading "/".
3857
3858 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3859 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3860 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3861 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3862
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003863 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3864 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3865 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3866 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003868 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003869 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3870
3871 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003872 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3873 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003874 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3875 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3876 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3877 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003878 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003879 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3880 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003881
3882 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3883 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3884 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3885 server will receive the request.
3886
3887 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3888 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3889 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3890 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3891 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003892 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3893 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3894 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003895
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003896 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3897 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3898 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3899 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3900 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003902 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003903 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3904 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3905 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3906
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003907 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3908 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3909 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3910
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003911 random
3912 random(<draws>)
3913 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003914 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3915 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3916 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3917 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003918 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3919 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3920 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3921 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3922 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3923 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3924 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3925 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3926 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3927 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3928 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3929 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3930 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3931 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3932 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3933 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3934 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3935 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3936 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3937 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003938
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003939 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003940 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003941 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3942 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3943 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3944 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3945 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3946 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003947 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003948 used instead.
3949
3950 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3951 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3952 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3953 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3954
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003955 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3956 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3957 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3958
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003959 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003960
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003961 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003962 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3963 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003964
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003965 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3966 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3967 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003968
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003969 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003970 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003971 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3972 NTLM relies on.
3973
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003974 Examples :
3975 balance roundrobin
3976 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003977 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003978 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3979 balance hdr(host)
3980 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003981
3982 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3983 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003985 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003986 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3987 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3988 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003989 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003990
3991 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3992 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3993 defaults to 16 kB.
3994
3995 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3996 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3997
3998 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3999 Round Robin.
4000
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004001 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004002 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4003 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4004 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4005
4006 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4007
4008 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004009 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004010 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4011 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4012 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004013
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004014 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004015
4016
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004017bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4018bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004019 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4021 no | yes | yes | no
4022 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004023 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4024 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4025 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4026 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004027 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004028 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4029 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4030 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4031 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4032 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4033 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004034 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004035 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4036 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004037 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004038 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4039 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004040 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004041 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4042 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004043 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004044 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004045 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4046 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4047 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004048 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4049 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4050 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4051 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004052 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4053 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4054 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004055
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004056 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4057 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004058 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4059 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4060 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004061 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4062 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4063 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4064 the range.
4065
4066 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4067 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4068 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4069 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4070 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4071 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4072 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004073 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004074 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004075
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004076 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004077 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004078 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4079 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4080 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4081 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4082 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4083 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4084
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004085 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4086 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4087 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4088 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4091 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4092 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4093 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4094 in a frontend.
4095
4096 Example :
4097 listen http_proxy
4098 bind :80,:443
4099 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004100 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004101
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004102 listen http_https_proxy
4103 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004104 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004105
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004106 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4107 bind ipv6@:80
4108 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4109 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4110
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004111 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004112 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004113
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004114 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4115 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4116 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4117 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4118 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4119
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004120 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004121 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004122
4123
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004124bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004127
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004128 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4129 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4130 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4131 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4132 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4133 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004134
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004135 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004136
4137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004138capture cookie <name> len <length>
4139 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4141 no | yes | yes | no
4142 Arguments :
4143 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4144 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4145 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4146 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004147 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004148
4149 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4150 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4151 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4152 right if it exceeds <length>.
4153
4154 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4155 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4156 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4157 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4158
4159 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4160 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4161 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4162
4163 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4164 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4165 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004166 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4167 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4168 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004169
4170 Example:
4171 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4172
4173 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004174 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004175
4176
4177capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004178 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4180 no | yes | yes | no
4181 Arguments :
4182 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004183 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004184 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4185 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4186 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4187
4188 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4189 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4190 it exceeds <length>.
4191
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004192 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004193 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4194 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004195 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4196 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4197 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4198 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004199 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004200 environments to find where the request came from.
4201
4202 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4203 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4204 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4205 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004206
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004207 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4208 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4209 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4210 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4211 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
4213 Example:
4214 capture request header Host len 15
4215 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004216 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004218 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004219 about logging.
4220
4221
4222capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004223 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4225 no | yes | yes | no
4226 Arguments :
4227 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004228 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004229 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4230 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4231 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4232
4233 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4234 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4235 it exceeds <length>.
4236
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004237 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004238 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4239 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4240 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004241 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4242 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4243 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4244 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004245
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004246 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4247 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4248 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4249 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4250 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004251
4252 Example:
4253 capture response header Content-length len 9
4254 capture response header Location len 15
4255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004256 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004257 about logging.
4258
4259
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004260clitcpka-cnt <count>
4261 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4262 the connection on the client side.
4263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4264 yes | yes | yes | no
4265 Arguments :
4266 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4267
4268 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4269 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004270 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4271 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004272
4273 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4274
4275
4276clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4277 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4278 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4279 client side.
4280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4281 yes | yes | yes | no
4282 Arguments :
4283 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4284 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4285 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4286 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4287
4288 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4289 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004290 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4291 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004292
4293 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4294
4295
4296clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4297 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4299 yes | yes | yes | no
4300 Arguments :
4301 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4302 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4303 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4304 document.
4305
4306 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4307 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004308 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4309 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004310
4311 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4312
4313
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004314compression algo <algorithm> ...
4315compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004316compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004317 Enable HTTP compression.
4318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4319 yes | yes | yes | yes
4320 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004321 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4322 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004323 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004324
4325 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004326 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4327 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4328 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004329
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004330 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004331 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004332
4333 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4334 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4335 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4336 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4337 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004338 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004339
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004340 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4341 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4342 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4343 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4344 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4345 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4346 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004347 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004348
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004349 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004350 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004351 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004352 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004353 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004354 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004355 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004356
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004357 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004358 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4359 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004360 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4361 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004362 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004363 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004364 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4365 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004366 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004367 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4368 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004369
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004370 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004371 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4372 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004373 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004374 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004375 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4376 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4377 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4378 "multipart"
4379 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4380 header
4381 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4382 and later
4383 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4384 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004385 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004386
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004387 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004388
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004389 Examples :
4390 compression algo gzip
4391 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004392
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004393
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004394cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004395 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4396 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004397 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004398 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4400 yes | no | yes | yes
4401 Arguments :
4402 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4403 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4404 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4405 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4406 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4407 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004408 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004409 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4410 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4411
4412 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004413 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004414 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4415 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4416 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4417 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004418 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4419 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004420 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004421 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4422 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004423
4424 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004425 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004426
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004427 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004428 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004429 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004430 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004431 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4432 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4433 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4434 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4435 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4436 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4437 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004438
4439 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4440 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4441 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4442 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4443 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4444 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4445 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4446 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4447 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004448 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004449 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4450 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4451 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004452
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004453 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4454 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4455 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004456 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4457 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4458 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4459 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004460 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4461 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4462 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463
4464 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4465 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4466 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4467 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4468 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4469 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4470 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4471 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4472 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4473
4474 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4475 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4476 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4477 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4478 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4479 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4480 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4481 persistence cookie in the cache.
4482 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4483
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004484 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4485 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004486 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004487 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4488 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004489 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004490 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4491 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4492 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4493 they logout.
4494
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004495 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004496 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4497 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4498 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4499
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004500 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004501 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4502 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4503 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4504 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4505 this attribute.
4506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004507 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004508 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004509 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4510 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4511 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4512 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4513 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4514 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004515
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004516 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4517 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4518 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4519 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4520 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4521 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4522 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4523 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004524 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004525 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4526 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4527 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4528 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4529 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4530 the site.
4531
4532 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4533 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4534 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4535 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4536 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4537 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4538 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4539 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4540 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4541 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4542 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4543 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4544 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004545 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004546 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4547 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4548
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004549 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4550 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4551 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4552 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4553 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4554 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4555
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004556 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004557 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4558 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4559 repeated.
4560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004561 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4562 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4563 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4564 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004566 Examples :
4567 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4568 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4569 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004570 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004571
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004572 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004573
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004574
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004575declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4576 Declares a capture slot.
4577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4578 no | yes | yes | no
4579 Arguments:
4580 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4581
4582 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4583 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4584 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4585 for use in the response.
4586
4587 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004588 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004589 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4590
4591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004592default-server [param*]
4593 Change default options for a server in a backend
4594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 yes | no | yes | yes
4596 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004597 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4598 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4599 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4600 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004601
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004602 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004603 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4604
4605 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004606
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004607
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004608default_backend <backend>
4609 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 yes | yes | yes | no
4612 Arguments :
4613 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4614
4615 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4616 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4617 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4618 will catch all undetermined requests.
4619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004620 Example :
4621
4622 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4623 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4624 default_backend dynamic
4625
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004626 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004628
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004629description <string>
4630 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4632 no | yes | yes | yes
4633 Arguments : string
4634
4635 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4636 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4637 it describes.
4638 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4639
4640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004641disabled
4642 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4644 yes | yes | yes | yes
4645 Arguments : none
4646
4647 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4648 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4649 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4650 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4651 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4652 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4653 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4654
4655 See also : "enabled"
4656
4657
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004658dispatch <address>:<port>
4659 Set a default server address
4660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004662 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004663
4664 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4665 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4666 during start-up.
4667
4668 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4669 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4670 possible with normal servers.
4671
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004672 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004673 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4674 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4675 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4676 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4677
4678 See also : "server"
4679
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004680
4681dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4682 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | no | yes | yes
4685 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4686
4687 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004688 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004689 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4690 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004691 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004692 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004694enabled
4695 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4697 yes | yes | yes | yes
4698 Arguments : none
4699
4700 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4701 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4702
4703 See also : "disabled"
4704
4705
4706errorfile <code> <file>
4707 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 yes | yes | yes | yes
4710 Arguments :
4711 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004712 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004713 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004714
4715 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004716 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004717 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004718 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4719 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004720
4721 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4722 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4723 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4724
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004725 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4726
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004727 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4728 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4729 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4730 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4731 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4732 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4733 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4734 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4735 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004737 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4738 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4739 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004740 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004741 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4742
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004743 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004744
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004745 Example :
4746 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004747 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004748 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4749 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4750
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004751
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004752errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4753 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4754 section.
4755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4756 yes | yes | yes | yes
4757 Arguments :
4758 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4759
4760 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004761 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004762 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4763 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004764
4765 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4766 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4767 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4768 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4769 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004770 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004771 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4772
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004773 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4774 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004775
4776 Example :
4777 errorfiles generic
4778 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4779
4780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004781errorloc <code> <url>
4782errorloc302 <code> <url>
4783 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 yes | yes | yes | yes
4786 Arguments :
4787 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004788 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004789 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004790
4791 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4792 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4793 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4794 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004795 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004796
4797 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4798 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4799 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4800
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004801 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4802
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004803 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4804 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4805 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4806 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004807 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004808 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4809 request.
4810
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004811 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004812
4813
4814errorloc303 <code> <url>
4815 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4817 yes | yes | yes | yes
4818 Arguments :
4819 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004820 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004821 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004822
4823 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4824 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4825 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4826 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004827 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004828
4829 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4830 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4831 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4832
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004833 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4834
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004835 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4836 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4837 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4838 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004839 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004840
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004841 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004842
4843
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004844email-alert from <emailaddr>
4845 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004846 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004847 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 yes | yes | yes | yes
4849
4850 Arguments :
4851
4852 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4853
4854 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4855 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4856
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004857 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004858 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4859 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004860
4861
4862email-alert level <level>
4863 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4864 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4865 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | yes | yes | yes
4867
4868 Arguments :
4869
4870 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4871 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4872 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4873
4874 By default level is alert
4875
4876 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4877 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4878 for the proxy.
4879
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004880 Alerts are sent when :
4881
4882 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4883 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4884 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4885 is notice or lower
4886 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4887 and a health check status update occurs
4888
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004889 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4890 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004891 section 3.6 about mailers.
4892
4893
4894email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4895 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4897 yes | yes | yes | yes
4898
4899 Arguments :
4900
4901 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4902
4903 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4904 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4905
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004906 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4907 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004908
4909
4910email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4911 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4912 mailers.
4913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | yes
4915
4916 Arguments :
4917
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004918 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004919
4920 By default the systems hostname is used.
4921
4922 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4923 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4924 for the proxy.
4925
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004926 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4927 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004928
4929
4930email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004931 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004932 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | yes | yes | yes
4935
4936 Arguments :
4937
4938 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4939
4940 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4941 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4942
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004943 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004944 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4945
4946
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004947error-log-format <string>
4948 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
4949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4950 yes | yes | yes | no
4951
4952 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
4953 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
4954 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
4955 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
4956 connection errors described in section 8.2.6..
4957 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
4958 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4959 string in depth.
4960
4961 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
4962 directives.
4963
4964
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004965force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4966 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004968 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004969
4970 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4971 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4972 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4973 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4974 marked down for maintenance operations.
4975
4976 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4977 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4978 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4979 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4980 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4981 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4982 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4983 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4984 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4985
4986 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4987 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4988 is used.
4989
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004990 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004991 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004992
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004993
4994filter <name> [param*]
4995 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 no | yes | yes | yes
4998 Arguments :
4999 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5000 referenced in section 9.
5001
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005002 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005003 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005004 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5005 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005006
5007 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5008 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5009
5010 Example:
5011 listen
5012 bind *:80
5013
5014 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5015 filter compression
5016 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5017
5018 compression algo gzip
5019 compression offload
5020
5021 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5022
5023 See also : section 9.
5024
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005025
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005026fullconn <conns>
5027 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5029 yes | no | yes | yes
5030 Arguments :
5031 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5032 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5033
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005034 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005035 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005036 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005037 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5038 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5039 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5040 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5041 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005042 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005043
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005044 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005045 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005046 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5047 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5048 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005049
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005050 Example :
5051 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5052 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5053 # connections.
5054 backend dynamic
5055 fullconn 10000
5056 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5057 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5058
5059 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5060
5061
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005062hash-balance-factor <factor>
5063 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5065 yes | no | no | yes
5066 Arguments :
5067 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5068 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005069 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005070
5071 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5072 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5073 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5074 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5075 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5076 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5077 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5078
5079 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5080 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5081 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5082 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5083 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5084
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005085 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5086 consistent hashing mechanism.
5087
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005088 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5089
5090
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005091hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005092 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5094 yes | no | yes | yes
5095 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005096 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5097 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005098
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005099 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5100 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5101 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5102 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5103 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5104 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5105 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5106 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5107 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5108 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005109
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005110 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5111 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5112 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5113 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5114 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5115 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5116 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5117 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5118 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5119 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5120 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5121 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5122 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005123 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5124 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005125
5126 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5127
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005128 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005129 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5130 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5131 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005132 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5133 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5134 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005135
5136 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5137 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005138 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5139 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5140 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5141 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5142
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005143 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005144 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5145 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5146 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5147 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5148 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5149 parameter.
5150
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005151 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5152 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5153 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5154 used on strings.
5155
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005156 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5157
5158 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5159 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5160 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5161 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5162 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5163 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5164 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5165 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5166 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5167 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5168 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5169 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005170
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005171 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5172 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5173 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005174
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005175 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005176
5177
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005178http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5179 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5180 ones).
5181
5182 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5183 no | yes | yes | yes
5184
5185 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5186 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5187 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5188 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5189 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5190 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5191
5192 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5193 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5194 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5195
5196 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5197 below.
5198
5199 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5200 instance.
5201
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005202 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5203 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5204 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5205
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005206 Example:
5207 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5208 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5209 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5210
5211http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5212
5213 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5214 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5215 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5216 example, or to pass some internal information.
5217 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5218 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5219 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5220
5221http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5222
5223 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5224 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5225
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005226http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005227
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005228 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5229 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5230 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5231 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5232 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005233
5234http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5235 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5236
5237 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5238
5239 Example:
5240 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5241
5242 # applied to:
5243 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5244
5245 # outputs:
5246 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5247
5248 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5249
5250http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5251 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5252
5253 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5254
5255 Example:
5256 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5257
5258 # applied to:
5259 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5260
5261 # outputs:
5262 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5263
5264http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5265
5266 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5267 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5268 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5269
5270http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5271 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5272
5273 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5274 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5275 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5276 fallback.
5277
5278 Example:
5279 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5280 http-response set-status 431
5281 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5282 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5283
5284http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5285
5286 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5287 inline.
5288
5289 Arguments:
5290 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5291 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5292 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5293 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5294 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5295 (request and response)
5296 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5297 processing
5298 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5299 processing
5300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5301 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5302 and '_'.
5303
5304 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5305 followed by some converters.
5306
5307 Example:
5308 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5309
5310http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5311
5312 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5313 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5314 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5315 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5316 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005317 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005318 processing.
5319
5320 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5321 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005322 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005323 rules evaluation.
5324
5325http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5326
5327 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5328 details about <var-name>.
5329
5330 Example:
5331 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5332
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005333
5334http-check comment <string>
5335 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5336 it fails.
5337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5338 yes | no | yes | yes
5339
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005340 Arguments :
5341 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5342 rule fails.
5343
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005344 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5345 user-friendly error reporting.
5346
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005347 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005348 "http-check expect".
5349
5350
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005351http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5352 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005353 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005354 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5356 yes | no | yes | yes
5357
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005358 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005359 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5360
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005361 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005362 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005363
5364 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5365 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5366 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5367 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5368
5369 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5370
5371 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5372
5373 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5374
5375 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5376
5377 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5378
5379 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5380 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5381 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5382 is used.
5383
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005384 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5385 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5386 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5387 haproxy -vv.
5388
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005389 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5390
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005391 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5392 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5393 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5394 different ports or with different servers.
5395
5396 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5397 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5398 the port with a "http-check connect".
5399
5400 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5401 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5402 do.
5403
5404 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5405 unset-var or comment rules.
5406
5407 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005408 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5409 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5410 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5411 option httpchk
5412
5413 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005414 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005415 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005416 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005417 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005418 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005419
5420 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5421
5422 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005423
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005424
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005425http-check disable-on-404
5426 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005428 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005429 Arguments : none
5430
5431 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5432 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5433 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5434 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5435 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5436 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5437 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5438 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005439 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5440 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005441 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5442 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5443 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005444
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005445 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005446
5447
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005448http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005449 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5450 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5451 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005452 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005454 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005455
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005456 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005457 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5458
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005459 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5460 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5461 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5462 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5463 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5464 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5465 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5466 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5467 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5468 result is always conclusive.
5469
5470 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5471 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5472 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005473 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5474 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005475 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5476 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005477 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5478 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5479 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005480
5481 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5482 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005483 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5484 supported :
5485 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5486 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005487 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5488 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5489 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5490 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5491 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005492
5493 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5494 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005495 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5496 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5497 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5498 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005499 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5500
5501 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5502 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5503 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5504 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5505
5506 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5507 informational message reported in logs if an error
5508 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5509 log-format string.
5510
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005511 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005512 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5513 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005514 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5515 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5516 details on the supported keywords.
5517
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005518 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5519 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5520 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5521 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005522
5523 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5524 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5525 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5526 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5527 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5528
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005529 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5530 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5531 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5532 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5533 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5534 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5535 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005536
5537 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005538 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005539 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5540 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5541 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5542 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5543
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005544 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5545 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005546 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5547 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5548 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5549 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5550 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5551 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5552 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5553 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005554 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5555 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5556 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5557 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5558 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5559 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5560 insensitive on the header names.
5561
5562 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5563 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5564 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5565 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5566 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5567 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005568
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005569 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005570 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005571 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5572 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5573 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5574 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5575 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005576 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005577 trace).
5578
5579 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005580 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005581 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5582 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5583 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5584 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5585 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005586 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005587
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005588 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5589 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5590 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5591 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5592 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5593 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5594
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005595 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005596 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005597 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5598 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5599 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5600 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5601 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5602 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5603
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005604 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5605 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5606 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5607 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5608 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005609
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005610 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5611 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5612
5613 Examples :
5614 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005615 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005616
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005617 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5618 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5619
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005620 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005621 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005622
5623 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005624 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005625
5626 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005627 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005628
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005629 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005630 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005631
5632
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005633http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005634 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5635 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005636 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5637 health checks.
5638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5639 yes | no | yes | yes
5640 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005641 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5642
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005643 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5644 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5645 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5646 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5647 to invent non-standard ones.
5648
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005649 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5650 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5651 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5652 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5653
5654 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5655 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5656 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5657 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005658
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005659 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005660 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005661 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005662 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5663 to add it.
5664
5665 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5666 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5667 to the log-format rules.
5668
5669 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5670 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5671 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005672
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005673 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5674 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5675 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5676 request.
5677
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005678 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5679 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5680 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005681 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5682 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5683 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5684 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005685 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005686
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005687 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005688 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5689 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005690
5691 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5692 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5693 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5694 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5695 configured request authority.
5696
5697 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5698 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005699
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005700 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005701
5702
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005703http-check send-state
5704 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5706 yes | no | yes | yes
5707 Arguments : none
5708
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005709 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005710 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005711 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5712 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5713 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005714
5715 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5716 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5717 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5718 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5719 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005720 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5721 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5722 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5723
5724 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5725 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5726 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5727
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005728 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5729 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5730 checked in multiple backends.
5731
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005732 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005733 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5734
5735 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5736 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5737 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5738 one fails.
5739
5740 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5741 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5742 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5743
5744 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5745 server's queue.
5746
5747 Example of a header received by the application server :
5748 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5749 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5750
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005751 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5752 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005753
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005754
5755http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005756 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5758 yes | no | yes | yes
5759
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005760 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005761 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5762 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5763 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5764 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5765 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5766 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5767 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5768 and '-'.
5769
5770 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5771
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005772 Examples :
5773 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005774
5775
5776http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005777 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5779 yes | no | yes | yes
5780
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005781 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005782 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5783 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5784 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5785 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5786 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5787 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5788 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5789 and '-'.
5790
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005791 Examples :
5792 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005794
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005795http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5796 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5797 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5798 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5799 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5801 yes | yes | yes | yes
5802 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005803 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005804 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005805 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005806 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005807
5808 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5809 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5810 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5811 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5812
5813 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5814 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5815 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5816 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5817
5818 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5819 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5820 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5821 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5822 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5823 chroot is performed.
5824
5825 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5826 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5827 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5828 considered.
5829
5830 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5831 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5832 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5833 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5834 considered as a raw string.
5835
5836 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5837 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5838 "content-type".
5839
5840 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5841 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5842 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5843 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5844 evaluated as a log-format string.
5845
5846 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5847 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5848 argument to "content-type".
5849
5850 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5851 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5852 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5853 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5854
5855 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5856 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5857 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5858 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5859 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5860 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5861 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5862 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5863
5864 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5865 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5866 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5867
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005868 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5869 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5870 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5871 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5872 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5873
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005874 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5875 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5876
5877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005878http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005879 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5880
5881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5882 no | yes | yes | yes
5883
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005884 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5885 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5886 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5887 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5888 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005889
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005890 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5891 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005893 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005895 Example:
5896 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5897 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5898 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005899
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005900 http-request allow if nagios
5901 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5902 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5903 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005905 Example:
5906 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5907 acl add path /addacl
5908 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005910 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005911
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005912 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5913 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005915 Example:
5916 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5917 acl setmap path /setmap
5918 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005921
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005922 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5923 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005925 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5926 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005928http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005929
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005930 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5931 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5932 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5933 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5934 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5935 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5936 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5937 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005938
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005939http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005941 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5942 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5943 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5944 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5945 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5946 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5947 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5948 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005952 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5953 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005954
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005955
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005956http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005957
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005958 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5959 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5960 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5961 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5962 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005963
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005964 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5965 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5966 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5967 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5968 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5969 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5970 instead.
5971
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005972 Example:
5973 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5974 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005975
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005976http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005977
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005978 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005980http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5981 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005983 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5984 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5985 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5986 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5987 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5988 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5989 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5990 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5991 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005993 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5994 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5995 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005996 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5997
5998 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5999 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6000 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6001 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006004
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006005 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6006 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6007 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6008 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6009 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6010 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006011
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006012http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006013
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006014 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6015 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6016 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6017 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6018 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006020http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006022 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6023 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6024 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6025 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6026 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6027 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006028
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006029http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6030http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6031 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6032 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6033 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6034 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006035
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006036 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6037 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6038 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006039 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006040 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6041 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6042 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006044 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006045
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006046http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6047 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6048 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6049 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6050
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006051http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6052
6053 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6054 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6055 pointed by <resolvers>.
6056 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6057 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6058 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6059 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6060 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6061 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6062 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6063 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6064 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6065 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6066 to 0.0.0.0.
6067
6068 Example:
6069 resolvers mydns
6070 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6071 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6072 timeout retry 1s
6073 hold valid 10s
6074 hold nx 3s
6075 hold other 3s
6076 hold obsolete 0s
6077 accepted_payload_size 8192
6078
6079 frontend fe
6080 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6081 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6082 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6083
6084 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6085 # which mean DNS resolution error
6086 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6087
6088 default_backend be
6089
6090 backend b_503
6091 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6092 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6093 # 503 error page to end users
6094
6095 backend be
6096 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6097 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6098 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6099 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6100 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6101
6102 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6103 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6104
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006105http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6106
6107 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6108 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6109 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6110 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006111 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6112 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006113
6114 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6115
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006116http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006117http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006118http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006119http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006120http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006121http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006122http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006123http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6124http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006125
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006126 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6127
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006128 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006129 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6130 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6131 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6132 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006133
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006134 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6135 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6136 the supported backend.
6137
6138 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6139 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6140 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6141 number of segments in the path.
6142
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006143 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6144 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6145 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6146 when improperly combined.
6147
6148 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6149 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6150 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6151 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6152 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6153
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006154 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006155
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006156 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6157
6158 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6159 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6160
6161 Example:
6162 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6163
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006164 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6165
6166 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6167 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6168
6169 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6170 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6171
6172 Example:
6173 - /#foo -> /
6174
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006175 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6176 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006177
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006178 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6179 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6180
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006181 Example:
6182 - /. -> /
6183 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6184 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6185 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006186
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006187 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6188 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6189
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006190 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006191 their preceding segment.
6192
6193 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6194 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6195
6196 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6197 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006198
6199 Example:
6200 - /foo/../ -> /
6201 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6202 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6203 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006204 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006205 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006206 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006207
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006208 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6209 removed as well:
6210
6211 Example:
6212 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6213 - /bar/../../ -> /
6214
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006215 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6216 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006217
6218 Example:
6219 - // -> /
6220 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6221
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006222 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6223 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6224
6225 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6226 ".", "_", and "~".
6227
6228 Example:
6229 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6230 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6231 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6232 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6233
6234 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6235 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6236
6237 Example:
6238 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6239 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6240
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006241 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006242 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006243
6244 Example:
6245 - /%6f -> /%6F
6246 - /%zz -> /%zz
6247
6248 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6249 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6250
6251 Example:
6252 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6253
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006254 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006255 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6256 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6257
6258 Example:
6259 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6260 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6261 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006263http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006264
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006265 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6266 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6267 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6268 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6269 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006271http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006273 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6274 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6275 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6276 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006278http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6279 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006280
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006281 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006282 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6283 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6284 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6285 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6286 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006287
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006288 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6289 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6290 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6291 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6292 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006293
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006294 Example:
6295 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6296
6297 # applied to:
6298 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6299
6300 # outputs:
6301 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6302
6303 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006304
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006305 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6306
6307 # applied to:
6308 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006309
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006310 # outputs:
6311 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006312
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006313http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6314 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6315
6316 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6317 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006318 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6319 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6320 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006321
6322 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6323 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6324 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6325
6326 Example:
6327 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6328 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6329
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006330 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6331 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6332 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6333 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6334
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006335http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6336 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6337
6338 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6339 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6340 query-string are replaced.
6341
6342 Example:
6343 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6344 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6345
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006346http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6347 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6348
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006349 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6350 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6351 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6352 against.
6353
6354 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6355 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6356 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006357
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006358 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6359 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6360 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6361 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6362 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6363 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6364 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6365 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6366 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006367 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6368 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006369
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006370 Example:
6371 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6372 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006373
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006374 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6375 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006377http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6378 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006379
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006380 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6381 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6382 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6383 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006384
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006385 Example:
6386 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006387
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006388 # applied to:
6389 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006390
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006391 # outputs:
6392 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006393
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006394http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6395 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6396 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006397 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006398 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6399
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006400 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006401 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6402 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006403 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006404 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006405 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006406 are followed to create the response :
6407
6408 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6409 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6410 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6411 ignored.
6412
6413 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6414 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006415 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006416 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6417 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006418
6419 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6420 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6421 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006422 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006423 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006424
6425 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6426 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6427 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006428 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006429 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006430 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006431
6432 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6433 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6434 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6435 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6436 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6437 as a raw content.
6438
6439 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6440 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6441 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6442 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6443 considered as a raw string.
6444
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006445 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006446 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6447 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6448 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6449
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006450 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6451 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006452 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006453
6454 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6455
6456 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006457 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006458 if { path /ping }
6459
6460 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6461 if { path /favicon.ico }
6462
6463 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6464 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6465 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6466
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006467http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6468
6469 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6470 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6471 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6472 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6473 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6474 at this index.
6475 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6476 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006478http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6479http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006481 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6482 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6483 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006484
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006485http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6486 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6487 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6488 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6489 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6490 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6491 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6492 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6493 at this index.
6494 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6495 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6496
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006497http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6498 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006499
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006500 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6501 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6502 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6503 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006505http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006507 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6508 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6509 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6510 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6511 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006513 Arguments:
6514 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6515 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006517 Example:
6518 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6519 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006521 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6522 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006524http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006526 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6527 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6528 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006530 Arguments:
6531 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6532 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006534 Example:
6535 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6536 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006538 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6539 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6540 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006542http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006544 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6545 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6546 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6547 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6548 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006550 Example:
6551 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6552 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6553 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6554 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6555 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6556 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6557 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6558 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6559 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006561http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006563 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6564 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6565 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6566 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6567 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006569http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6570 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6573 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6574 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6575 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6576 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6577 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6578 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6579 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6580 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006582http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006583
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006584 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6585 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6586 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6587 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6588 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6589 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6590 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006591 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6592 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6597 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6598 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006600http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006602 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6603 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6604 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6605 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6606 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6607 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6608 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6609 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006613 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6614 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6615 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6616 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6617 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6618 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 Example :
6621 # prepend the host name before the path
6622 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006623
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006624http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6625
6626 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6627 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6628 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006630http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6633 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6634 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6635 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6636 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006640 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6641 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6642 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6643 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6644 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6645 values have higher priority.
6646 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6647 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6648 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6649 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6650 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006652http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6655 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6656 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6657 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6658 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6659 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6660 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006662 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006663
6664 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6666 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006668http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6669 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6670 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6671 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006672 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6673 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674
6675 Arguments :
6676 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6677 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006678
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006679 See also "option forwardfor".
6680
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006681 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006682 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6683 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6684
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006685 # After the masking this will track connections
6686 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6687 http-request track-sc0 src
6688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006689 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6690 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6691
6692http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6693
6694 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6695 expression.
6696
6697 Arguments:
6698 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6699 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006700
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006701 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006702 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6703 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6704
6705 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6706 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6707 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6708
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006709http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006710 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6711
6712 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6713 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6714 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6715 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6716 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6717
6718 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6719 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6720 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6721 results.
6722
6723 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006724 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6725 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006727http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6728
6729 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6730 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6731 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6732 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6733 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6734 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6735 information from the request.
6736
6737 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6738
6739http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6740
6741 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6742 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6743 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6744 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6745 path and the query string.
6746 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6747
6748http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6749
6750 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6751 inline.
6752
6753 Arguments:
6754 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6755 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6756 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6757 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6758 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6759 (request and response)
6760 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6761 processing
6762 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6763 processing
6764 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6765 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6766 and '_'.
6767
6768 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6769 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006770
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006771 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006772 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006774http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6775 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006777 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6778 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6779 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6780 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6781 agent name must be used.
6782
6783 Arguments:
6784 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6785
6786 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6787 configuration.
6788
6789http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6790
6791 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6792 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6793 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6794 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6795 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6796 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6797 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6798 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6799 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6800 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6801 action.
6802 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6803 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6804 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6805 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6806 you fully understand how it works.
6807
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006808http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6809
6810 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6811 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6812 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6813 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6814 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006815 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006816 processing.
6817
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006818 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006819 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6820 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6821 rules evaluation.
6822
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006823http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6824http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6825 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6826 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6827 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6828 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006829
6830 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6831 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6832 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006833 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6834 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6835 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6836 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6837 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6838 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006839 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006840 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6841 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6842 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006843 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006844 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6845 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6846 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6847 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6848 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006849
6850http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6851http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6852http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6853
6854 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6855 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6856 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6857 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006858 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006859 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6860 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6861 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6862 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6863 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6864 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6865 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6866
6867 Arguments :
6868 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6869 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6870 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6871 select which table entry to update the counters.
6872
6873 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6874 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6875 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6876 that table until the session ends.
6877
6878 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6879 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6880 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6881 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6882 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6883 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6884 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6885 useful information.
6886
6887 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6888 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6889 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6890 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6891 checks that make use of it.
6892
6893http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6894
6895 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006896
6897 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006898 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006899
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006900http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6901
6902 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6903 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6904 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6905 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6906 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6907 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6908
6909 Arguments :
6910 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6911
6912 Example:
6913 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6914
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006915http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6916 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6917
6918 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6919 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6920 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6921 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6922 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6923 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6924 http-buffer-request".
6925
6926 Arguments :
6927
6928 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6929 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6930
6931 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006932 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006933 bytes.
6934
6935 Example:
6936 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6937
6938 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006940http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006941
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006942 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6943 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6944 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006945
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006947http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006948 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6949
6950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6951 no | yes | yes | yes
6952
6953 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6954 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6955 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6956 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6957 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6958 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006960 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6961 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006963 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006965 Example:
6966 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006968 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006970 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6971 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006973 Example:
6974 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006976 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006978 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6979 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006981 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6982 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006984http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006986 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6987 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6988 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6989 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6990 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6991 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6992 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6993 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006995http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006997 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6998 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6999 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7000 example, or to pass some internal information.
7001 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7002 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7003 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007004
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007005http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007007 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7008 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007009
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007010http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007011
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007012 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007014http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007016 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7017 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7018 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7019 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7020 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7021 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7022 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007024 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7025 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7026 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7027 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7028 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007029
7030 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7031 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7032 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7033 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007035http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007037 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7038 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7039 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7040 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7041 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7042 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007043
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007044http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007045
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007046 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7047 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7048 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7049 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7050 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7055 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7056 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7057 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7058 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7059 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007060
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007061http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7062http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7063 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7064 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7065 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7066 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007067
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007068 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7069 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7070 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007071 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007072 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7073 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7074 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007075 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007076 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007080 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7081 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7082 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7083 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7084 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7085 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7088 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007089
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007090 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7091 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007093 Example:
7094 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096 # applied to:
7097 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007099 # outputs:
7100 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007102 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007104http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7105 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007106
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007107 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007108 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007110 Example:
7111 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007113 # applied to:
7114 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007116 # outputs:
7117 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007118
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007119http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7120 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7121 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007122 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007123 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7124
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007125 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007126 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7127 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007128 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007129 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007130 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007131 are followed to create the response :
7132
7133 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7134 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7135 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7136 ignored.
7137
7138 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7139 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007140 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007141 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7142 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007143
7144 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7145 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7146 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007147 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007148 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007149
7150 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7151 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7152 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007153 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007154 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007155 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007156
7157 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7158 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7159 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7160 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7161 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7162 as a raw content.
7163
7164 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7165 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7166 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7167 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7168 considered as a raw string.
7169
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007170 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7171 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7172 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7173 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7174
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007175 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7176 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007177 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007178
7179 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7180
7181 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007182 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007183 if { status eq 404 }
7184
7185 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7186 string "This is the end !" \
7187 if { status eq 500 }
7188
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007189http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7190
7191 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7192 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7193 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7194 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7195 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7196 at this index.
7197 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7198 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007200http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7201http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007203 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7204 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7205 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007206
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007207http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7208 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7209
7210 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7211 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7212 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7213 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7214 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7215 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7216 at this index.
7217 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7218 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7219
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007220http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7221 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007222
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007223 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7224 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7225 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7226 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007227
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007228http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7229 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007230
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007231 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7232 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7233 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7234 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7235 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007236
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007237 Arguments:
7238 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007239
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007240 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7241 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007242
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007243http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007244
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007245 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7246 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7247 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007249http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7250
7251 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7252 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7253 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7254 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7255 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7256
7257http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7258
7259 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7260 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7261 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7262 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7263 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7264 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7265 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7266 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7267 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7268
7269http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7270
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007271 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7272 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7273 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7274 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
7275 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7276 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7277 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007278 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7279 and OpenBSD.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007280
7281http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7282
7283 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7284 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7285 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7286 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7287 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7288 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7289 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7290 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7291
7292http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7293 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7294
7295 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7296 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7297 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7298 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007299
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007300 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007301 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7302 http-response set-status 431
7303 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7304 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007305
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007306http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007307
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007308 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7309 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7310 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7311 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7312 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7313 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7314 based on some information from the request.
7315
7316 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7317
7318http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7319
7320 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7321 inline.
7322
7323 Arguments:
7324 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7325 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7326 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7327 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7328 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7329 (request and response)
7330 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7331 processing
7332 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7333 processing
7334 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7335 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7336 and '_'.
7337
7338 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7339 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007340
7341 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007342 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007343
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007344http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007345
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007346 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7347 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7348 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7349 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7350 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7351 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7352 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7353 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7354 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7355 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7356 action.
7357 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7358 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7359 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7360 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7361 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007362
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007363http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7364
7365 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7366 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7367 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7368 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7369 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007370 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007371 processing.
7372
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007373 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007374 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007375 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007376 rules evaluation.
7377
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007378http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7379http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7380http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007381
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007382 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7383 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7384 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7385 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7386 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007387 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007388
7389http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7390
7391 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7392 about <var-name>.
7393
7394 Example:
7395 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7396
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007397http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7398 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7399
7400 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7401 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7402 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7403 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7404 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7405 buffer is full.
7406
7407 Arguments :
7408
7409 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7410 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7411
7412 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007413 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007414 bytes.
7415
7416 Example:
7417 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007418
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007419http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7420 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7421
7422 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 yes | no | yes | yes
7424
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007425 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007426 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7427 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7428 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007429
7430 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7431
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007432 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7433 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7434 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7435 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7436 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7437 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7438 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007439 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007440 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7441 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007442
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007443 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7444 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7445 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7446 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7447 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7448 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7449 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007450 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7451 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7452 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7453 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7454 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7455 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007456
7457 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7458 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7459 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7460 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7461 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7462 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7463 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7464 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007465 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007466 downsides of rare connection failures.
7467
7468 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7469 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7470 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7471 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7472 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7473 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007474 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007475 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7476 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7477 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7478 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7479 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7480
7481 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007482 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7483 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7484 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7485 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007486
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007487 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7488 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007489
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007490 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007491
7492 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7493 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7494 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7495
7496 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7497
7498
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007499http-send-name-header [<header>]
7500 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007501 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7502 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007503 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007504 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7505
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007506 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7507 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7508 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7509 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7510 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7511 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7512 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7513 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7514 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7515 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7516 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7517 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7518 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7519 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7520 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7521 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007522
7523 See also : "server"
7524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007525id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007526 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7528 no | yes | yes | yes
7529 Arguments : none
7530
7531 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7532 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7533 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007534
7535
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007536ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7537 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7538 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007539 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007540
7541 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7542 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7543 and running).
7544
7545 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7546 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7547 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007548 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007549 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7550
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007551 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7552 "unless" condition is met.
7553
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007554 Example:
7555 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7556 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7557 ignore-persist if url_static
7558
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007559 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7560
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007561load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7562 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7563 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7564 yes | no | yes | yes
7565
7566 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7567 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7568 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007569 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007570 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007571 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7572 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7573 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7574
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007575 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007576 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007577 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007578
7579 Arguments:
7580 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7581 named "server-state-file".
7582
7583 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7584 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7585 name is used as a file name.
7586
7587 none don't load any stat for this backend
7588
7589 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007590 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7591 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7592 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007593 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007594 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007595
7596 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7597 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7598
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007599 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007600
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007601 global
7602 stats socket /tmp/socket
7603 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007604
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007605 defaults
7606 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007607
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007608 backend bk
7609 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7610 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007611
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007612
7613 Then one can run :
7614
7615 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7616
7617 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7618
7619 1
7620 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7621 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7622 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7623
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007624 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007625
7626 global
7627 stats socket /tmp/socket
7628 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7629
7630 defaults
7631 load-server-state-from-file local
7632
7633 backend bk
7634 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7635 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7636
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007637
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007638 Then one can run :
7639
7640 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7641
7642 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7643
7644 1
7645 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7646 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7647 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7648
7649 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7650 "show servers state"
7651
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007652
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007653log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007654log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007655 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007656no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007657 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7659 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007660
7661 Prefix :
7662 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7663 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7664 prefix does not allow arguments.
7665
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007666 Arguments :
7667 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7668 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7669 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7670 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7671 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7672 parameter.
7673
7674 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7675 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7676
7677 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7678 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7679 standard syslog port).
7680
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007681 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7682 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7683 standard syslog port).
7684
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007685 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7686 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7687 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007688 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007689
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007690 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7691 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7692 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7693 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7694 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7695 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7696 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7697 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7698 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7699 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7700 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7701 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007702 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007703 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7704 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7705 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007706 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7707 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007708
7709 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7710 and "fd@2", see above.
7711
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007712 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7713 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7714 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7715 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7716 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7717 having the logs instantly available.
7718
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007719 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7720 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7721 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7722
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007723 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7724 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007725
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007726 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7727 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7728 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7729 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7730 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7731 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7732 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7733 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7734 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7735 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007736 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007737
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007738 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7739 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7740 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7741 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7742 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7743
7744 <sample_size>
7745 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7746 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7747 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7748 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7749 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7750
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007751 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7752 one of the following :
7753
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007754 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7755 field is stripped. This is the default.
7756 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7757 rfc3164.
7758
7759 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007760 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7761
7762 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7763 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7764
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007765 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7766 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7767 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7768 designed to be used with a local log server.
7769
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007770 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7771 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7772 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7773 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7774 systemd logger consumes.
7775
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007776 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7777 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7778 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7779 used with a local log server.
7780
7781 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7782 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7783 designed to be used with a local log server.
7784
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007785 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7786 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7787 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7788 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7789
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007790 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7791
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007792 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7793 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7794 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7795
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007796 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7797 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7798 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7799 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007800
7801 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7802 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7803 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007804 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7805 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7806 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7807 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7808 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007809
7810 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7811
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007812 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7813 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7814 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007815
7816 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7817 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7818 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7819 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7820
7821 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7822 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007823
7824 Example :
7825 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007826 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7827 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7828 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007829 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007830 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7831 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007832 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007834
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007835log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007836 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7837 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7838 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007839
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007840 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7841 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7842 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7843 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7844 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02007845 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
7846 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007847
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007848 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7849 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007850
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007851log-format-sd <string>
7852 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7854 yes | yes | yes | no
7855
7856 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7857 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7858 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7859 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7860 which covers the log format string in depth.
7861
7862 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7863 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7864
7865 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7866 log format to "rfc5424".
7867
7868 Example :
7869 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7870
7871
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007872log-tag <string>
7873 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7875 yes | yes | yes | yes
7876
7877 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7878 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007879 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007880 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7881 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7882 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7883 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7884 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7885 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007886
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007887max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7888 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7889 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7890 yes | no | yes | yes
7891
7892 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7893 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7894 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7895 servers.
7896
7897 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007898 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007899 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7900 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7901 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007902 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007903 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7904 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7905 picking a different server.
7906
7907 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7908 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7909 even if they have to be queued.
7910
7911 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7912 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7913
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007914max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7915 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7916 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7917 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007918
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007919maxconn <conns>
7920 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7922 yes | yes | yes | no
7923 Arguments :
7924 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7925 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7926 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7927 closes.
7928
7929 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007930 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007931 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7932 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007933 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7934 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7935 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7936 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007937
7938 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7939 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7940 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7941
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007942 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7943 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007944
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007945 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7946
7947
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007948mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007949 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7951 yes | yes | yes | yes
7952 Arguments :
7953 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7954 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7955 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7956 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7957
7958 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7959 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7960 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7961 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7962 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7963
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007964 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7965 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7966 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007967
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007968 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007969 defaults http_instances
7970 mode http
7971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007972
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007973monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007974 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7976 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007977 Arguments :
7978 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7979 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007980 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007981 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7982 backend and its backup.
7983
7984 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7985 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7986 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7987 servers in a list of backends.
7988
7989 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7990 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7991 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007992 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007993 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7994 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007995 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007996 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7997 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007998
7999 Example:
8000 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008001 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008002 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8003 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8004 monitor-uri /site_alive
8005 monitor fail if site_dead
8006
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008007 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008008
8009
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008010monitor-uri <uri>
8011 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8013 yes | yes | yes | no
8014 Arguments :
8015 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8016 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8017
8018 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8019 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8020 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8021 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8022 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8023 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8024 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8025 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8026
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008027 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008028 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8029 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8030 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8031 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8032 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8033 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008034
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008035 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8036 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8037 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8038 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8039
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008040 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008041 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008042 frontend www
8043 mode http
8044 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8045
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008046 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008047
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008048
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008049option abortonclose
8050no option abortonclose
8051 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 yes | no | yes | yes
8054 Arguments : none
8055
8056 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8057 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8058 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8059 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008060 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008061 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8062 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8063 encountered while delivering the response.
8064
8065 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8066 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8067 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8068 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8069 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8070 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008071 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008072 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008073 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008074 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8075 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8076 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8077
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008078 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8079 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008080 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8081 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8082 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8083 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8084 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8085 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008086 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008087
8088 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8089 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8090
8091 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8092
8093
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008094option accept-invalid-http-request
8095no option accept-invalid-http-request
8096 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8098 yes | yes | yes | no
8099 Arguments : none
8100
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008101 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008102 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008103 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008104 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8105 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8106 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8107 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8108 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008109 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8110 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8111 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8112 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008113 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008114 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008115 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8116 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8117 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008118
8119 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8120 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8121 been confirmed.
8122
8123 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8124 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008125 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8126 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008127 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8128
8129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8131
8132 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8133 stats socket.
8134
8135
8136option accept-invalid-http-response
8137no option accept-invalid-http-response
8138 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8140 yes | no | yes | yes
8141 Arguments : none
8142
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008143 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008144 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008145 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008146 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8147 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8148 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8149 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8150 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008151 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8152 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8153 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008154
8155 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8156 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8157 been confirmed.
8158
8159 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8160 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8161 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8162 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8163
8164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8166
8167 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8168 stats socket.
8169
8170
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008171option allbackups
8172no option allbackups
8173 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8175 yes | no | yes | yes
8176 Arguments : none
8177
8178 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8179 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8180 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8181 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8182 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8183 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8184 order between the backup servers anymore.
8185
8186 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8187 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8188
8189 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8190 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8191
8192
8193option checkcache
8194no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008195 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8197 yes | no | yes | yes
8198 Arguments : none
8199
8200 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8201 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008202 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008203 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8204 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008205 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008206
8207 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008208 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008209 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008210 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8211 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008212 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008213 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008214 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8215 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008216 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008217 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8218 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008219 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008220 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8221 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8222 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8223 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8224 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8225 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8226 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8227 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8228 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8229
8230 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008231 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8232 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8233 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8234 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008235
8236 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8237 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008238 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008239 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008240
8241 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8242 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8243
8244
8245option clitcpka
8246no option clitcpka
8247 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8249 yes | yes | yes | no
8250 Arguments : none
8251
8252 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8253 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008254 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008255 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8256
8257 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8258 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8259 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8260 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8261
8262 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8263 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8264 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8265 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8266 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8267
8268 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8269
8270 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8271 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8272 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8273
8274 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8275 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8276
8277 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8278
8279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008280option contstats
8281 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8283 yes | yes | yes | no
8284 Arguments : none
8285
8286 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8287 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8288 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008289 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008290 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8291 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8292 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8293 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8294 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008295
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008296option disable-h2-upgrade
8297no option disable-h2-upgrade
8298 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8299 connection.
8300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8301 yes | yes | yes | no
8302 Arguments : none
8303
8304 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8305 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8306 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8307 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008308 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8309 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8310 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8311 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8312 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8313 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008314
8315 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8316 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008317
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008318option dontlog-normal
8319no option dontlog-normal
8320 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8322 yes | yes | yes | no
8323 Arguments : none
8324
8325 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8326 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8327 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8328 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8329 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8330 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8331 logged.
8332
8333 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8334 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8335 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008337 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008338 logging.
8339
8340
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008341option dontlognull
8342no option dontlognull
8343 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8345 yes | yes | yes | no
8346 Arguments : none
8347
8348 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8349 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8350 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8351 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8352 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8353 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008354 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8355 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8356 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008357
8358 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008359 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008360 would not be logged.
8361
8362 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8363 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8364
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008365 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008366 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008367
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008368
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008369option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008370 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8372 yes | yes | yes | yes
8373 Arguments :
8374 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8375 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008376 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008377 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008378
8379 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8380 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8381 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8382 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8383 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8384 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8385 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008386 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8387 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8388 possible that the client has already brought one.
8389
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008390 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008391 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008392 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008393 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008394 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008395 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008396
8397 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8398 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8399 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8400 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8401 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8402 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008403 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008404
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008405 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8406 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008407 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008408 are under the control of the end-user.
8409
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008410 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008411 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8412 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008413 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8414 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8415 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008416
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008417 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008418 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8419 frontend www
8420 mode http
8421 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8422
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008423 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8424 backend www
8425 mode http
8426 option forwardfor header X-Client
8427
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008428 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008429 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008430
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008431
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008432option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8433no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8434 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8436 yes | yes | yes | no
8437 Arguments : none
8438
8439 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8440 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8441 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8442 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8443 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8444 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8445 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8446
8447 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8448 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8449 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8450 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8451 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8452 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8453 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8454 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8455 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8456 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8457
8458 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8459
8460 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8461 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8462
8463 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8464 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8465
8466
8467option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8468no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8469 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8471 yes | no | yes | yes
8472 Arguments : none
8473
8474 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8475 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8476 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8477 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8478 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8479 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8480 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8481
8482 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8483 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8484 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8485 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8486 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8487 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8488 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8489 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8490 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8491 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8492
8493 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8494
8495 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8496 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8497
8498 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8499 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8500
8501
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008502option http-buffer-request
8503no option http-buffer-request
8504 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8506 yes | yes | yes | yes
8507 Arguments : none
8508
8509 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8510 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8511 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8512 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8513 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8514 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008515 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8516 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8517 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8518 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008519
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008520 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8521 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008522
8523
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008524option http-ignore-probes
8525no option http-ignore-probes
8526 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8528 yes | yes | yes | no
8529 Arguments : none
8530
8531 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8532 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8533 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8534 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8535 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8536 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8537 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8538 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8539 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008540 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8541 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008542 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8543
8544 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8545 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8546 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8547 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8548 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8549 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8550 are often the only way to detect them.
8551
8552 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8553 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8554
8555 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8556
8557
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008558option http-keep-alive
8559no option http-keep-alive
8560 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8562 yes | yes | yes | yes
8563 Arguments : none
8564
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008565 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8566 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008567 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8568 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008569 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8570 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8571 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008572
8573 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8574 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008575 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8576 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8577 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8578 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8579 situations where this option may be useful :
8580
8581 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008582 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008583
8584 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8585 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8586
8587 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8588 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8589 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8590 request.
8591
8592 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8593 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008594 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8595 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8596 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008597
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008598 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8599 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8600 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8601 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8602 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8603 not set.
8604
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008605 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8606 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8607 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008608
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008609 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008610 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008611 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008612
8613
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008614option http-no-delay
8615no option http-no-delay
8616 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8618 yes | yes | yes | yes
8619 Arguments : none
8620
8621 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8622 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8623 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8624 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8625 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8626 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8627 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008628 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008629 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8630 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8631 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8632 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8633 affected.
8634
8635 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8636 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8637 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8638 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8639 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8640 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8641 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8642 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8643 latency environments.
8644
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008645 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8646
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008647
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008648option http-pretend-keepalive
8649no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008650 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008652 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008653 Arguments : none
8654
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008655 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008656 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8657 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8658 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008659 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008660 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8661 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8662 consider the response complete.
8663
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008664 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008665 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008666 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008667 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008668 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008669 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8670
8671 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8672 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8673 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8674 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008675 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8676 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008677 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8678
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008679 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8680 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8681 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8682 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8683 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8684 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008685
8686 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8687 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8688
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008689 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008690 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008691
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008692
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008693option http-server-close
8694no option http-server-close
8695 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8697 yes | yes | yes | yes
8698 Arguments : none
8699
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008700 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8701 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8702 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8703 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008704 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8705 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8706 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8707 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8708 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8709 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8710 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8711 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8712 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8713 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8714 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008715
8716 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8717 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8718 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8719 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008720 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8721 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008722
8723 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8724 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008725 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8726 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8727 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008728
8729 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8730 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8731
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008732 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8733 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008734
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008735option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008736no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008737 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8739 yes | yes | yes | no
8740 Arguments : none
8741
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008742 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008743 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8744 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8745 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8746 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8747 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008748 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008749
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008750 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008751 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008752 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8753 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8754 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008755
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008756 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8757 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8758 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8759 front of an existing proxy.
8760
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008761 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8762
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008763 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008764
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008765option httpchk
8766option httpchk <uri>
8767option httpchk <method> <uri>
8768option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008769 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8771 yes | no | yes | yes
8772 Arguments :
8773 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8774 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8775 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8776 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8777 ones.
8778
8779 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8780 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8781 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8782
8783 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8784 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8785 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008786 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008787
8788 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8789 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8790 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8791 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8792 the lack of any response.
8793
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008794 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8795 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8796 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8797 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8798
8799 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8800 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8801 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008802
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008803 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8804 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008805 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008806 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008807 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008808
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008809 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8810 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8811 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8812 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8813
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008814 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008815 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8816 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8817 backend https_relay
8818 mode tcp
8819 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8820 http-check send hdr Host www
8821 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008822
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008823 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8824 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8825 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008826
8827
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008828option httpclose
8829no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008830 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8832 yes | yes | yes | yes
8833 Arguments : none
8834
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008835 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8836 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8837 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8838 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008839 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008840
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008841 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8842 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008843 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008844 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8845 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008846
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008847 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8848 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8849 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008850
8851 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8852 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008853 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8854 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8855 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008856
8857 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8858 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8859
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008860 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008861
8862
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008863option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008864 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008866 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008867 Arguments :
8868 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8869 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8870 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008871 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008872 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008873
8874 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8875 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8876 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8877 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8878 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8879 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8880 ports.
8881
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008882 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8883 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008884
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008885 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008887 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008888
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008889option httpslog
8890 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8892 yes | yes | yes | no
8893
8894 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8895 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8896 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8897 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8898 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8899 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8900 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8901
8902 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8903
8904 See also : section 8 about logging.
8905
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008906
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008907option independent-streams
8908no option independent-streams
8909 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8911 yes | yes | yes | yes
8912 Arguments : none
8913
8914 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8915 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8916 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8917 receive data or not.
8918
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008919 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008920 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8921 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8922 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8923 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8924 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8925 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8926 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8927 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8928 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8929 socket buffers.
8930
8931 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8932 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8933 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8934 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8935 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8936
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008937 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008938
8939
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008940option ldap-check
8941 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8943 yes | no | yes | yes
8944 Arguments : none
8945
8946 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8947 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8948 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8949 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8950
8951 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8952 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8953
8954 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8955 configure it.
8956
8957 Example :
8958 option ldap-check
8959
8960 See also : "option httpchk"
8961
8962
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008963option external-check
8964 Use external processes for server health checks
8965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8966 yes | no | yes | yes
8967
8968 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8969 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8970 command".
8971
8972 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8973
8974 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8975
8976
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008977option log-health-checks
8978no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008979 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8981 yes | no | yes | yes
8982 Arguments : none
8983
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008984 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8985 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8986 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008987
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008988 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8989 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8990 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8991 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8992 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8993
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008994 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008995 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008996
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008997 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8998 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8999 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009000
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009001
9002option log-separate-errors
9003no option log-separate-errors
9004 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9006 yes | yes | yes | no
9007 Arguments : none
9008
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009009 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009010 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9011 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9012 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9013 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9014 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9015 provides very important information.
9016
9017 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9018 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9019 error logs.
9020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009021 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009022 logging.
9023
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009024
9025option logasap
9026no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009027 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9029 yes | yes | yes | no
9030 Arguments : none
9031
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009032 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9033 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9034 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9035 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9036
9037 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9038 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9039 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9040 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9041 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009042 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009043 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9044 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9045 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9046 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009047 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009048
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009049 Examples :
9050 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9051 mode http
9052 option httplog
9053 option logasap
9054 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9055
9056 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9057 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9058 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9059 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009061 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009062 logging.
9063
9064
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009065option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009066 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9068 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009069 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009070 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9071 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009072 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9073 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009074
9075 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9076 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009077 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009078 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009079 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9080 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9081 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009082
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009083 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9084 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9085 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009086
9087 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009088 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009089 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9090 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9091 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9092 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9093 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9094 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9095 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9096
9097 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9098 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009099
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009100 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009101
9102 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9103 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9104 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9105 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009106 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009107 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009108
9109 See also: "option httpchk"
9110
9111
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009112option nolinger
9113no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009114 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009117 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009118
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009119 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009120 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9121 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9122 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9123 connections.
9124
9125 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9126 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009127 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9128 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9129 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9130 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9131 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9132 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9133 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9134 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9135 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9136 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9137 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9138 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9139 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009140
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009141 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9142 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9143 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9144 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9145 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009146
9147 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9148 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009149 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009150 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009151 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009152
9153 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9154 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9155
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009156 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9157 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009158
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009159option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9160 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9162 yes | yes | yes | yes
9163 Arguments :
9164 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9165 matching <network>
9166 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9167 header name.
9168
9169 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9170 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9171 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9172 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9173 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9174 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9175 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9176 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9177 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9178 possible that the client has already brought one.
9179
9180 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9181 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9182 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9183 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9184 header and requires different one.
9185
9186 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9187 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9188 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009189 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9190 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9191 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9192 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9193 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009194
9195 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9196 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9197 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9198 both are defined.
9199
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009200 Examples :
9201 # Original Destination address
9202 frontend www
9203 mode http
9204 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9205
9206 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9207 backend www
9208 mode http
9209 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009211 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009212
9213
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009214option persist
9215no option persist
9216 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9218 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009219 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009220
9221 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9222 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9223 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9224 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9225 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9226 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9227 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9228 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9229 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9230 redirected to another valid server.
9231
9232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9234
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009235 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009236
9237
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009238option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9239 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9241 yes | no | yes | yes
9242 Arguments :
9243 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9244 PostgreSQL server.
9245
9246 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9247 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9248 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9249 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9250
9251 See also: "option httpchk"
9252
9253
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009254option prefer-last-server
9255no option prefer-last-server
9256 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9257 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9258 yes | no | yes | yes
9259 Arguments : none
9260
9261 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009262 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009263 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9264 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009265 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009266 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009267 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009268 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9269 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009270 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009271 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009272 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9273 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9274 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009275 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9276 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9277 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009278
9279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9281
9282 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9283
9284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009285option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009286option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009287no option redispatch
9288 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9290 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009291 Arguments :
9292 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9293 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9294 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009295 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009296 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009297 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009298 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9299 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9300 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009302
9303 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9304 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9305 be able to access the service anymore.
9306
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009307 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9308 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009309
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009310 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9311 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9312 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9313 following order:
9314
9315 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9316
9317 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9318 list, or
9319
9320 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9321
9322 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9323 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9324
9325 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9326 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9327 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9328 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9329
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009330 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009331 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9332 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9336
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009337 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009338
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009339
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009340option redis-check
9341 Use redis health checks for server testing
9342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9343 yes | no | yes | yes
9344 Arguments : none
9345
9346 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9347 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9348 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9349 find the "+PONG" response message.
9350
9351 Example :
9352 option redis-check
9353
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009354 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009355
9356
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009357option smtpchk
9358option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9359 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9361 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009362 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009363 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009364 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009365 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9366
9367 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9368 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9369 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9370
9371 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9372 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9373 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9374 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9375 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9376 dead server.
9377
9378 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9379 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009380 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009381 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9382
9383 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9384 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9385 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9386 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009387 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009388
9389 Example :
9390 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9391
9392 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009395option socket-stats
9396no option socket-stats
9397
9398 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9400 yes | yes | yes | no
9401
9402 Arguments : none
9403
9404
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009405option splice-auto
9406no option splice-auto
9407 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9409 yes | yes | yes | yes
9410 Arguments : none
9411
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009412 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009413 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009414 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009415 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009416 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009417 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9418 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9419 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9420 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9421
9422 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9423 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9424 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9425 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9426 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9427 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9428 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9429 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9430 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9431 keyword.
9432
9433 Example :
9434 option splice-auto
9435
9436 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9437 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9438
9439 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9440 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9441
9442
9443option splice-request
9444no option splice-request
9445 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9447 yes | yes | yes | yes
9448 Arguments : none
9449
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009450 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009451 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009452 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9453 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9454 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9455 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9456
9457 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9458
9459 Example :
9460 option splice-request
9461
9462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9464
9465 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9466 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9467
9468
9469option splice-response
9470no option splice-response
9471 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9473 yes | yes | yes | yes
9474 Arguments : none
9475
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009476 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009477 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009478 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9479 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9480 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9481 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9482
9483 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9484
9485 Example :
9486 option splice-response
9487
9488 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9489 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9490
9491 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9492 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9493
9494
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009495option spop-check
9496 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9498 no | no | no | yes
9499 Arguments : none
9500
9501 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9502 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9503 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9504 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9505
9506 Example :
9507 option spop-check
9508
9509 See also : "option httpchk"
9510
9511
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009512option srvtcpka
9513no option srvtcpka
9514 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9516 yes | no | yes | yes
9517 Arguments : none
9518
9519 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9520 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009521 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009522 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9523
9524 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9525 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9526 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9527 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9528
9529 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9530 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9531 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9532 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9533 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9534
9535 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9536
9537 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9538 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9539 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9540
9541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9543
9544 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9545
9546
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009547option ssl-hello-chk
9548 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9550 yes | no | yes | yes
9551 Arguments : none
9552
9553 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9554 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9555 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9556 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9557 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9558 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9559 hello message.
9560
9561 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9562 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9563 messages, which is appreciable.
9564
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009565 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009566 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9567 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009568
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009569 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9570
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009571
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009572option tcp-check
9573 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9575 yes | no | yes | yes
9576
9577 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9578 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9579
9580 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9581 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9582 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9583
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009584 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009585 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9586 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9587 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9588 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9589 only.
9590
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009591 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009592 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009593 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9594 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9595 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9596
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009597 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009598 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9599 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009600 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009601 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9602 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9603 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9604 the respective protocols.
9605 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009606 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009607
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009608 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009609
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009610 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9611 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9612 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9613 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009614
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009615 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9616 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9617 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009618
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009619
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009620 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009621 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009622 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009623 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009624
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009625 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009626 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009627 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009628
9629 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9630 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009631 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009632 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009633 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009634 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009635 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009636 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009637 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9638 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009639 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009640 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9641 tcp-check expect string +OK
9642
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009643 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009644 (send many headers before analyzing)
9645 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009646 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009647 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9648 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9649 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9650 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009651 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009652
9653
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009654 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009655
9656
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009657option tcp-smart-accept
9658no option tcp-smart-accept
9659 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9661 yes | yes | yes | no
9662 Arguments : none
9663
9664 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9665 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9666 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9667 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9668 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9669 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9670
9671 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9672 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9673 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9674 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9675
9676 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9677 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9678 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009679 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009680
9681 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9682 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9683 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9684
9685 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9686 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9687 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9688
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009689 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9690
9691
9692option tcp-smart-connect
9693no option tcp-smart-connect
9694 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9696 yes | no | yes | yes
9697 Arguments : none
9698
9699 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9700 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9701 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9702 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9703 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9704
9705 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9706 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9707 complex.
9708
9709 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9710 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9711 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9712
9713 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9714 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9715
9716 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9717
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009718
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009719option tcpka
9720 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9722 yes | yes | yes | yes
9723 Arguments : none
9724
9725 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9726 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009727 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009728 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9729
9730 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9731 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9732 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9733 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9734
9735 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9736 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9737 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9738 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9739 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9740
9741 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9742
9743 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9744 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9745 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9746 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9747 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9748 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9749 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9750 backends.
9751
9752 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9753
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009754
9755option tcplog
9756 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009758 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009759 Arguments : none
9760
9761 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9762 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9763 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9764 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9765 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9766 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9767 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9768 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9769
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009770 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009772 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009773
9774
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009775option transparent
9776no option transparent
9777 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009779 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009780 Arguments : none
9781
9782 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9783 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9784 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9785 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9786 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9787 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9788 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9789 appropriate server.
9790
9791 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9792 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9793
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009794 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009795 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009796
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009797
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009798external-check command <command>
9799 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9801 yes | no | yes | yes
9802
9803 Arguments :
9804 <command> is the external command to run
9805
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009806 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9807
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009808 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009809
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009810 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9811 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9812 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9813 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9814 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9815 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009816
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009817 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9818
9819 Environment variables :
9820 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9821 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9822
9823 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9824
9825 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9826
9827 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9828 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9829 for a UNIX socket).
9830
9831 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9832
9833 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9834
9835 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9836
9837 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9838
9839 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9840
9841 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9842 socket).
9843
9844 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9845 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9846
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009847 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9848
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009849 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9850 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9851 failed.
9852
9853 Example :
9854 external-check command /bin/true
9855
9856 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9857
9858
9859external-check path <path>
9860 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9862 yes | no | yes | yes
9863
9864 Arguments :
9865 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9866
9867 The default path is "".
9868
9869 Example :
9870 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9871
9872 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9873 "external-check command"
9874
9875
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009876persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009877persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009878 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9880 yes | no | yes | yes
9881 Arguments :
9882 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009883 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9884 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009885
9886 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9887 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009888 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009889 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9890 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9891 forwarded to this server.
9892
9893 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9894 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9895 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009896 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009897 a single "listen" section.
9898
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009899 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9900 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9901 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9902
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009903 Example :
9904 listen tse-farm
9905 bind :3389
9906 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9907 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9908 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9909 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9910 persist rdp-cookie
9911 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009912 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009913 balance rdp-cookie
9914 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9915 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9916
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009917 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9918 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009919
9920
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009921rate-limit sessions <rate>
9922 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9924 yes | yes | yes | no
9925 Arguments :
9926 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9927 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9928
9929 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9930 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9931 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009932 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009933 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9934 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9935
9936 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9937 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9938 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9939 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9940
9941 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9942 listen smtp
9943 mode tcp
9944 bind :25
9945 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009946 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009947
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009948 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9949 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9950 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009951
9952 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9953
9954
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009955redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9956redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9957redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009958 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9960 no | yes | yes | yes
9961
9962 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009963 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009964
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009965 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009966 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009967 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9968 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9969 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009970
9971 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9972 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9973 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9974 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9975 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009976 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9977 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9978 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9979 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009980
9981 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9982 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9983 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9984 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9985 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9986 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009987 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009988 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009989 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9990 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9991 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009992
9993 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009994 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9995 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9996 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009997 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009998 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9999 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10000 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10001 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010002
10003 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010004 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010005
10006 - "drop-query"
10007 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10008 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10009 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10010 with a location-type redirect.
10011
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010012 - "append-slash"
10013 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10014 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10015 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10016 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10017
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010018 - "ignore-empty"
10019 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10020 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10021 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10022 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10023 of known paths using a simple map.
10024
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010025 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10026 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10027 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10028 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10029 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10030 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10031 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10032
10033 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10034 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10035 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10036 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10037 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10038 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10039 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010040
10041 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10042 acl clear dst_port 80
10043 acl secure dst_port 8080
10044 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010045 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010046 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010047 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10048
10049 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010050 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10051 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10052 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010053 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010054
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010055 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10056 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10057 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10058
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010059 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010060 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010061
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010062 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010063 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10064 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10065 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010066
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010067 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10068 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10069 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010071 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010072
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010073
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010074retries <value>
10075 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10076 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10077 yes | no | yes | yes
10078 Arguments :
10079 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10080 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10081 default value is 3.
10082
10083 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10084 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10085 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10086
10087 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010088 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10089 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010090
10091 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10092 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10093
10094 See also : "option redispatch"
10095
10096
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010097retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010098 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10099 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10100 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10102 yes | no | yes | yes
10103 Arguments :
10104 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10105 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10106 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10107 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10108
10109 none never retry
10110
10111 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10112 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10113
10114 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10115 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10116 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10117 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10118 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10119 processing the request.
10120
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010121 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10122 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10123 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10124 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10125 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10126 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10127 overflow attack for example).
10128
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010129 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10130 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10131 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10132 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10133 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10134 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10135 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10136 amplify denial of service attacks.
10137
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010138 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10139 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10140 considered to be safe to retry.
10141
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010142 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10143 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10144 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10145 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10146 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010147
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010148 all-retryable-errors
10149 retry request for any error that are considered
10150 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10151 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10152 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10153
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010154 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10155 not cumulative.
10156
10157 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10158 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10159 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10160 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10161
10162 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10163 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10164 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10165 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10166 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10167 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10168 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10169 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10170 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10171 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10172 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10173 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10174
10175 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10176 should not use this directive.
10177
10178 The default is "conn-failure".
10179
10180 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10181
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010182server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010183 Declare a server in a backend
10184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10185 no | no | yes | yes
10186 Arguments :
10187 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010188 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010189 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010190
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010191 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10192 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10193 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10194 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010195 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10196 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010197 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010198 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10199 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010200 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10201 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10202 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10203 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10204 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10205 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10206 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010207 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010208 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10209 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10210 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10211 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10212 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10213 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010214 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10215 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010216 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10217 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010218
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010219 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010220 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10221 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10222 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10223 adding this value to the client's port.
10224
10225 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10226 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010227 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010228
10229 Examples :
10230 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10231 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010232 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010233 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10234 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10235 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010236
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010237 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10238 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10239 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10240 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10241 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10242
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010243 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10244 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010245
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010246server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010247 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010248 this backend.
10249 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10250 no | no | yes | yes
10251
10252 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10253 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10254 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10255 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10256 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010257
10258 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10259 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10260
10261 global
10262 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10263
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010264 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010265 load-server-state-from-file
10266
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010267 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010268 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010269
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010270server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10271 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10272 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10274 no | no | yes | yes
10275
10276 Arguments:
10277 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10278
10279 <num | range>
10280 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10281 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10282 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10283 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10284
10285 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10286
10287 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10288
10289 <params*>
10290 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10291 keyword.
10292
10293 Examples:
10294 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10295 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10296 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10297
10298 # or
10299 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10300
10301 # would be equivalent to:
10302 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10303 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10304 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10305
10306
10307
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010308source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010309source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010310source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010311 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10313 yes | no | yes | yes
10314 Arguments :
10315 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10316 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010317
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010318 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010319 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10320 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10321 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10322 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10323 supported prefixes are :
10324 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10325 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10326 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010327 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010328 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10329 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010330
10331 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10332 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010333 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10334 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10335 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010336
10337 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10338 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10339 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10340 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10341 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10342 <addr>.
10343
10344 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10345 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10346 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10347 port.
10348
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010349 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10350 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10351 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10352 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010353 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010354 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10355 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10356 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10357 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10358 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10359 HTTP header.
10360
10361 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10362 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010363 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010364 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10365 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10366 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10367 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10368 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10369 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10370 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10371
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010372 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10373 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10374 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10375 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10376 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10377 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10378
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010379 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10380 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10381 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10382 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10383
10384 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10385 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10386 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10387 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10388 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10389 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10390
10391 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10392 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10393 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10394 there are two methods :
10395
10396 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10397 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10398 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10399 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10400 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10401 of the client ranges may be used.
10402
10403 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10404 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10405 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10406 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10407 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10408 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10409 same session.
10410
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010411 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10412 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10413 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010414 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010415
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010416 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10417
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010418 Examples :
10419 backend private
10420 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10421 source 192.168.1.200
10422
10423 backend transparent_ssl1
10424 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10425 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10426
10427 backend transparent_ssl2
10428 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10429 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10430 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10431
10432 backend transparent_ssl3
10433 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10434 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10435 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10436
10437 backend transparent_smtp
10438 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10439 # with Tproxy version 4.
10440 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10441
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010442 backend transparent_http
10443 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10444 # proxy.
10445 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010447 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010448 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10449
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010450
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010451srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10452 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10453 the connection on the server side.
10454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10455 yes | no | yes | yes
10456 Arguments :
10457 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10458
10459 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10460 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010461 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10462 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010463
10464 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10465
10466
10467srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10468 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10469 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10470 server side.
10471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10472 yes | no | yes | yes
10473 Arguments :
10474 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10475 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10476 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10477 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10478
10479 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10480 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010481 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10482 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010483
10484 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10485
10486
10487srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10488 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10490 yes | no | yes | yes
10491 Arguments :
10492 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10493 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10494 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10495 document.
10496
10497 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10498 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010499 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10500 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010501
10502 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10503
10504
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010505stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10506 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010508 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010509
10510 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10511 matched.
10512
10513 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10514 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10515
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010516 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10517 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10518 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10519 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010520
10521 Example :
10522 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10523 backend stats_localhost
10524 stats enable
10525 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10526
10527 Example :
10528 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10529 backend stats_auth
10530 stats enable
10531 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10532 stats admin if TRUE
10533
10534 Example :
10535 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10536 userlist stats-auth
10537 group admin users admin
10538 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10539 group readonly users haproxy
10540 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10541
10542 backend stats_auth
10543 stats enable
10544 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10545 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10546 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10547 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10548
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010549 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10550 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010551
10552
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010553stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10554 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010556 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010557 Arguments :
10558 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10559
10560 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10561
10562 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10563 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10564 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10565 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10566 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10567 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10568
10569 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10570 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10571 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010572 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010573
10574 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10575 report using "stats scope".
10576
10577 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10578 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10579 unobvious parameters.
10580
10581 Example :
10582 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10583 backend public_www
10584 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10585 stats enable
10586 stats hide-version
10587 stats scope .
10588 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010589 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010590 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10591 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10592
10593 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10594 backend private_monitoring
10595 stats enable
10596 stats uri /admin?stats
10597 stats refresh 5s
10598
10599 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10600
10601
10602stats enable
10603 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010605 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010606 Arguments : none
10607
10608 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10609 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10610 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10611 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10612 - stats auth : no authentication
10613 - stats scope : no restriction
10614
10615 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10616 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10617 unobvious parameters.
10618
10619 Example :
10620 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10621 backend public_www
10622 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10623 stats enable
10624 stats hide-version
10625 stats scope .
10626 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010627 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010628 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10629 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10630
10631 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10632 backend private_monitoring
10633 stats enable
10634 stats uri /admin?stats
10635 stats refresh 5s
10636
10637 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10638
10639
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010640stats hide-version
10641 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010643 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010644 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010645
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010646 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10647 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10648 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10649 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10650 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10651 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010653 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10654 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10655 unobvious parameters.
10656
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010657 Example :
10658 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10659 backend public_www
10660 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010661 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010662 stats hide-version
10663 stats scope .
10664 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010665 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010666 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10667 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010668
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010669 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10670 backend private_monitoring
10671 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010672 stats uri /admin?stats
10673 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010674
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010675 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010676
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010677
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010678stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10679 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10680 Access control for statistics
10681
10682 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10683 no | no | yes | yes
10684
10685 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10686 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10687 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10688 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10689 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10690 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10691
10692 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10693 instance.
10694
10695 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10696 about ACL usage.
10697
10698
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010699stats realm <realm>
10700 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010702 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010703 Arguments :
10704 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10705 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10706 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10707
10708 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10709 using a backslash ('\').
10710
10711 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10712 only related to authentication.
10713
10714 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10715 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10716 unobvious parameters.
10717
10718 Example :
10719 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10720 backend public_www
10721 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10722 stats enable
10723 stats hide-version
10724 stats scope .
10725 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010726 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010727 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10728 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10729
10730 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10731 backend private_monitoring
10732 stats enable
10733 stats uri /admin?stats
10734 stats refresh 5s
10735
10736 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10737
10738
10739stats refresh <delay>
10740 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010742 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010743 Arguments :
10744 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10745 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10746 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10747 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10748 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10749 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10750
10751 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10752 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10753 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010754 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010755
10756 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10757 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10758 unobvious parameters.
10759
10760 Example :
10761 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10762 backend public_www
10763 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10764 stats enable
10765 stats hide-version
10766 stats scope .
10767 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010768 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010769 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10770 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10771
10772 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10773 backend private_monitoring
10774 stats enable
10775 stats uri /admin?stats
10776 stats refresh 5s
10777
10778 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10779
10780
10781stats scope { <name> | "." }
10782 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010784 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010785 Arguments :
10786 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10787 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10788 section in which the statement appears.
10789
10790 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10791 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10792 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10793 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10794 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10795 exists.
10796
10797 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10798 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10799 unobvious parameters.
10800
10801 Example :
10802 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10803 backend public_www
10804 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10805 stats enable
10806 stats hide-version
10807 stats scope .
10808 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010809 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010810 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10811 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10812
10813 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10814 backend private_monitoring
10815 stats enable
10816 stats uri /admin?stats
10817 stats refresh 5s
10818
10819 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10820
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010821
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010822stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010823 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010825 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010826
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010827 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010828 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10829
10830 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10831 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10832
10833 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10834 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010835 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010836
10837 Example :
10838 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10839 backend private_monitoring
10840 stats enable
10841 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10842 stats uri /admin?stats
10843 stats refresh 5s
10844
10845 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10846 global section.
10847
10848
10849stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010850 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10852 yes | yes | yes | yes
10853 Arguments : none
10854
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010855 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010856 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10857 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10858 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10859 - IP (socket, server)
10860 - cookie (backend, server)
10861
10862 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10863 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010864 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010865
10866 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10867
10868
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010869stats show-modules
10870 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10872 yes | yes | yes | yes
10873 Arguments : none
10874
10875 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10876 values as a tooltip.
10877
10878 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10879 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10880 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10881
10882 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10883
10884
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010885stats show-node [ <name> ]
10886 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010888 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010889 Arguments:
10890 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10891 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10892
10893 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10894 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010895 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010896
10897 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10898 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10899 unobvious parameters.
10900
10901 Example:
10902 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10903 backend private_monitoring
10904 stats enable
10905 stats show-node Europe-1
10906 stats uri /admin?stats
10907 stats refresh 5s
10908
10909 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10910 section.
10911
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010912
10913stats uri <prefix>
10914 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010916 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010917 Arguments :
10918 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10919 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10920 query string.
10921
10922 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10923 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10924 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10925 possible to reach it in the application.
10926
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010927 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010928 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010929 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10930 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10931 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10932 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10933
10934 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10935 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10936 an address or a port to statistics only.
10937
10938 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10939 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10940 unobvious parameters.
10941
10942 Example :
10943 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10944 backend public_www
10945 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10946 stats enable
10947 stats hide-version
10948 stats scope .
10949 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010951 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10952 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10953
10954 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10955 backend private_monitoring
10956 stats enable
10957 stats uri /admin?stats
10958 stats refresh 5s
10959
10960 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10961
10962
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010963stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10964 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010966 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010967
10968 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010969 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010970 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010971 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010972 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10973
10974 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10975 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10976 the "stick-table" statement.
10977
10978 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10979 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10980 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10981 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10982 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10983
10984 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10985 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10986 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10987 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10988 transformation rules.
10989
10990 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10991 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10992 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10993 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10994 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10995 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10996 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10997
10998 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10999 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11000 ACL based conditions.
11001
11002 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11003 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11004 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11005 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11006
11007 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11008 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11009 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11010 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11011
11012 Example :
11013 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11014 # last 30 minutes
11015 backend pop
11016 mode tcp
11017 balance roundrobin
11018 stick store-request src
11019 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11020 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11021 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11022
11023 backend smtp
11024 mode tcp
11025 balance roundrobin
11026 stick match src table pop
11027 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11028 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11029
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011030 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11031 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011032
11033
11034stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11035 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11037 no | no | yes | yes
11038
11039 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11040 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11041 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11042 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11043
11044 Examples :
11045 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011046 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011047
11048 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11049 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11050 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11051
11052
11053 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11054 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11055 backend http
11056 mode http
11057 balance roundrobin
11058 stick on src table https
11059 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11060 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11061 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11062
11063 backend https
11064 mode tcp
11065 balance roundrobin
11066 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11067 stick on src
11068 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11069 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11070
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011071 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011072
11073
11074stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11075 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11077 no | no | yes | yes
11078
11079 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011080 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011081 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011082 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011083 server is selected.
11084
11085 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11086 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11087 the "stick-table" statement.
11088
11089 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11090 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11091 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11092 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11093 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11094 address.
11095
11096 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11097 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11098 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11099 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11100 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11101 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11102 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11103 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11104 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11105 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11106
11107 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11108 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11109 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11110 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11111 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11112 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11113 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11114
11115 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11116 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11117 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11118 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11119
11120 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11121 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11122 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11123 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11124 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11125 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011126 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11127 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11128 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11129 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11130 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11131 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011132
11133 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11134 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11135 the request.
11136
11137 Example :
11138 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11139 # last 30 minutes
11140 backend pop
11141 mode tcp
11142 balance roundrobin
11143 stick store-request src
11144 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11145 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11146 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11147
11148 backend smtp
11149 mode tcp
11150 balance roundrobin
11151 stick match src table pop
11152 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11153 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11154
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011155 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011156
11157
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011158stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011159 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011160 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011161 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011163 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011164
11165 Arguments :
11166 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11167 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11168 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11169 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11170
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011171 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11172 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11173 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11174 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11175
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011176 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11177 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11178 instance.
11179
11180 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11181 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11182 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11183 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11184 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11185 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011186 to 32 characters.
11187
11188 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11189 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11190 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011191 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011192 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11193 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011194
11195 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011196 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11197 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011198 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11199 increase.
11200
11201 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011202 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11203 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11204 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011205
11206 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011207 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011208 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11209 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011210 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011211 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11212 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11213 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11214 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11215 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11216 parameter (see below).
11217
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011218 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11219 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11220 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11221 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11222 soft restart.
11223
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011224 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11225 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11226 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11227 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011228 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011229 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011230 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11231 if not expiration delay is specified.
11232
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011233 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11234 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11235 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11236 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11237 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11238 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11239 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11240 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11241 token.
11242
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011243 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11244 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11245 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11246 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011247 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11248 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11249 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11250 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11251 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11252 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11253 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11254 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11255 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11256 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11257 types and their arguments.
11258
11259 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11260 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11261 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11262 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11263
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011264 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11265 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11266 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11267 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11268 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11269 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11270 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11271 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11272 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11273 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011274 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11275 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11276 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11277 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011278
11279 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11280 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11281 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11282 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11283 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11284 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11285 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11286 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11287 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11288 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11289 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11290 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011291 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11292 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11293 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11294 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011295
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011296 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11297 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11298 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011299 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011300
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011301 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11302 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11303 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011304 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011305 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011306 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011307
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011308 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11309 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11310 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11311 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11312
11313 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11314 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11315 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11316 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11317 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11318 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11319
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011320 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11321 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11322 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11323 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11324 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11325 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11326 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11327 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11328 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11329 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011330 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11331 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11332 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011333
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011334 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11335 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11336 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11337 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11338
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011339 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11340 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11341 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11342 they were received.
11343
11344 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11345 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11346 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11347 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11348 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11349
11350 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11351 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11352 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11353 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11354 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11355
11356 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11357 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11358 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11359
11360 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11361 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11362 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11363 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11364 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11365
11366 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11367 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11368 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11369 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11370 the client side.
11371
11372 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11373 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11374 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11375 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11376 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11377 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11378 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11379
11380 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11381 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11382 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11383 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11384 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11385 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011386 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011387
11388 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11389 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11390 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11391 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11392 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11393 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11394
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011395 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11396 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11397 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11398 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11399 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11400
11401 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11402 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11403 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11404 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11405 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11406 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11407
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011408 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011409 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011410 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11411 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11412
11413 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11414 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11415 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11416 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11417 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11418 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11419 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11420 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11421 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11422 recommended for better fairness.
11423
11424 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011425 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011426 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11427 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11428
11429 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11430 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11431 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11432 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11433 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11434 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11435 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11436 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11437 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11438 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011439
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011440 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11441 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011442 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11443 reference it.
11444
11445 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11446 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011447 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11448 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11449 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011450
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011451 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11452 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11453 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11454 something that can be ignored.
11455
11456 Example:
11457 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11458 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11459 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11460 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11461
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011462 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011463 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011464
11465
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011466stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011467 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11469 no | no | yes | yes
11470
11471 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011472 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011473 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011474 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011475 server is selected.
11476
11477 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11478 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11479 the "stick-table" statement.
11480
11481 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11482 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11483 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11484 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11485
11486 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11487 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11488 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11489 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11490 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11491 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011492 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011493 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11494 rules.
11495
11496 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11497 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11498 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11499 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11500 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11501 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11502 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11503
11504 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11505 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11506 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11507 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11508
11509 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11510 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11511 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11512 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11513 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11514 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011515 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11516 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11517 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11518 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11519 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11520 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11521 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11522 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11523 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011524
11525 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11526
11527 Example :
11528 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11529 backend https
11530 mode tcp
11531 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011532 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011533 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011534
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011535 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11536 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11537
11538 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11539 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11540 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11541
11542 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11543 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011544
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011545 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11546 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11547 # at offset 44.
11548
11549 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11550 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11551
11552 # Learn on response if server hello.
11553 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011554
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011555 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11556 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11557
11558 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11559 extraction.
11560
11561
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011562tcp-check comment <string>
11563 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11564 it fails.
11565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11566 yes | no | yes | yes
11567
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011568 Arguments :
11569 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11570 rule fails.
11571
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011572 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11573 user-friendly error reporting.
11574
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011575 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11576 "tcp-check expect".
11577
11578
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011579tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11580 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011581 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011582 Opens a new connection
11583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011584 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011585
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011586 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011587 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11588
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011589 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011590 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011591
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011592 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011593 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11594 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011595 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011596
11597 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011598
11599 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11600
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011601 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11602
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011603 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11604
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011605 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11606
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011607 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11608 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11609 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11610 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11611
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011612 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11613 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11614 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11615 haproxy -vv.
11616
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011617 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011618
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011619 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11620 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11621 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11622
11623 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11624 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11625 of the sequence.
11626
11627 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11628 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11629 do.
11630
11631 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11632 unset-var or comment rules.
11633
11634 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011635 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11636 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11637 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11638 option tcp-check
11639 tcp-check connect
11640 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11641 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11642 tcp-check send \r\n
11643 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11644 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11645 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11646 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11647 tcp-check send \r\n
11648 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11649 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11650
11651 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11652 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011653 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011654 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11655 tcp-check connect port 143
11656 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11657 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11658
11659 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11660
11661
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011662tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011663 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011664 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011665 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011666 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011668 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011669
11670 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011671 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11672
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011673 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11674 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11675 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11676 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11677 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11678 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11679 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11680 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11681 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11682 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11683
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011684 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011685 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11686 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011687 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11688 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11689 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11690
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011691 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11692 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11693 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011694 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11695 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011696 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11697 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011698 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11699 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011700 By default "L7OK" is used.
11701
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011702 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11703 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011704 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11705 supported :
11706 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11707 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011708 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11709 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11710 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11711 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11712 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011713
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011714 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011715 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011716 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11717 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11718 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11719 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011720 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11721
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011722 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11723 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11724 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11725 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11726
11727 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11728 informational message reported in logs if an error
11729 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11730 log-format string.
11731
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011732 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11733 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11734 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11735 followed by some converters.
11736
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011737 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11738 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11739 with the usual backslash ('\').
11740 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011741 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011742 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11743 used upper or lower case.
11744
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011745 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11746
11747 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11748 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11749 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11750 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11751 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11752 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11753 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11754 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11755
11756 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11757 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11758 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11759 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11760 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11761 expression.
11762
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011763 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11764 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11765 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11766 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11767 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11768 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11769
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011770 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11771 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11772 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11773 this exact hexadecimal string.
11774 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11775
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011776 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11777 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11778 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11779 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11780 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11781 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11782 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11783 size.
11784
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011785 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11786 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11787 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11788 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11789 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11790 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11791 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11792 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11793 in a binary string before matching the response's
11794 buffer.
11795
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011796 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011797 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011798 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11799 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11800 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11801 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11802 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11803 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11804 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11805 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11806 the null character.
11807
11808 Examples :
11809 # perform a POP check
11810 option tcp-check
11811 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11812
11813 # perform an IMAP check
11814 option tcp-check
11815 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11816
11817 # look for the redis master server
11818 option tcp-check
11819 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011820 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011821 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11822 tcp-check expect string role:master
11823 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11824 tcp-check expect string +OK
11825
11826
11827 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011828 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011829
11830
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011831tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11832tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11833 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11834 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011835 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011836 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011837
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011838 Arguments :
11839 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11840
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011841 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11842 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011843
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011844 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11845 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011846
11847 Examples :
11848 # look for the redis master server
11849 option tcp-check
11850 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11851 tcp-check expect string role:master
11852
11853 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011854 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011855
11856
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011857tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11858tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11859 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11860 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011862 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011863
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011864 Arguments :
11865 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011866
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011867 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11868 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011869
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011870 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11871 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11872 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011873
11874 Examples :
11875 # redis check in binary
11876 option tcp-check
11877 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11878 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11879
11880
11881 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011882 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011883
11884
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011885tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011886 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011888 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011889
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011890 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011891 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11892 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11893 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11894 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11895 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11896 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11897 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11898 and '-'.
11899
11900 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11901
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011902 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011903 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11904
11905
11906tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011907 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011909 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011910
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011911 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011912 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11913 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11914 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11915 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11916 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11917 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11918 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11919 and '-'.
11920
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011921 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011922 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11923
11924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011925tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11926 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11928 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011929 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011930 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11931 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011932
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011933 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011934
11935 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11936 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011937 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11938 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11939 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11940 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11941 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11942 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011943
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011944 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11945 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11946 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11947 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011948
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011949 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011950 - accept :
11951 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11952 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11953 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011955 - reject :
11956 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11957 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11958 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11959 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11960 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11961 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11962 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11963 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11964 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11965 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11966 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011967 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011968
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011969 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11970 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11971 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11972 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11973 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11974 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11975 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11976 hosts.
11977
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011978 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11979 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11980 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11981 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11982 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11983 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11984 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11985 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11986
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011987 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11988 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11989 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11990 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11991 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11992 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11993 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11994 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11995 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011996 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11997 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011998
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011999 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012000 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012001 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12002 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12003 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012004 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012005 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012006 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12007 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12008 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12009 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12010 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12011 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12012 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012013
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012014 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012015 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012016 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012017 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012018 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12019 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12020 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012021
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012022 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12023 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12024 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12025 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012026
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012027 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12028 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12029 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12030 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12031 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012032 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12033 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12034 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12035 layer7 information is extracted.
12036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012037 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12038 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12039 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12040 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12041 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012042
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012043 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12044 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12045 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12046 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12047 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12048 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12049 no GPC stored at this index.
12050 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12051 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12052 data_types).
12053
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012054 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12055 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12056 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12057 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12058
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012059 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12060 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12061 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12062 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12063
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012064 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12065 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12066 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12067 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12068 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12069 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12070 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12071 no GPT stored at this index.
12072 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12073 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12074
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012075 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12076 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12077 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12078 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12079 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012080
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012081 - set-mark <mark>:
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +010012082 Is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the client
12083 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value
12084 is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by
12085 the routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
12086 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
12087 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
12088 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works
12089 on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +010012090 on FreeBSD and OpenBSD.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012091
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012092 - set-src <expr> :
12093 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12094 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12095 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012096 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012098 Arguments:
12099 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12100 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012101
12102 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012103 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12104
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012105 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12106 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012107
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012108 - set-src-port <expr> :
12109 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12110 expression.
12111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012112 Arguments:
12113 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12114 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012115
12116 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012117 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12118
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012119 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12120 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12121 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012122
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012123 - set-dst <expr> :
12124 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12125 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12126 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12127 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12128 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12129
12130 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12131 followed by some converters.
12132
12133 Example:
12134
12135 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12136 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12137
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012138 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12139 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12140
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012141 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12142 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12143 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12144 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12145
12146
12147 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12148 followed by some converters.
12149
12150 Example:
12151
12152 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12153
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012154 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12155 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12156 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12157
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012158 - set-tos <tos>:
12159 Is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12160 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
12161 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed
12162 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only
12163 the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
12164 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border
12165 routers based on some information from the request.
12166
12167 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
12168
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012169 - "silent-drop" :
12170 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012171 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012172 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12173 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12174 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12175 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12176 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012177 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12178 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012179 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12180 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012181 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012182 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12183 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12184 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12185 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12186
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012187 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12188 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12189 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012191 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12192 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12193 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012194
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012195 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012196 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012197 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012199 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12200 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12201 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012202
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012203 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012204 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12205 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012206
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012207 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12208
12209 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12210
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012211 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12212
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012213 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012214
12215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012216tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12217 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012219 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012220 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012221 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12222 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012223
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012224 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012225
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012226 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012227 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12228 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012229 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12230 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012231
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012232 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12233 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12234 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12235 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012236 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012237 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012238 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12239 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12240 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12241 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012242 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012243 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012244
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012245 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12246 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12247 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12248 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012249
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012250 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012251 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012252 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012253 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12254 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012255 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012256 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012257 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012258 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012259 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012260 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012261 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012262 - set-dst <expr>
12263 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012264 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012265 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012266 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012267 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012268 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012269 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012270 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012271 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012272 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012273 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012275 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12276 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012277 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12278 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012279
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012280 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12281 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12282 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12283 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12284 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12285 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012287 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012288 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12289 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012290
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012291 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12292 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12293 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12294 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12295 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12296 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012298 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012299 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12300 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12301 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12302 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12303 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12304 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12305 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12306 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12307 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12308 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012309
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012310 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012311 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12312 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12313 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012314
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012315 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12316 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12317
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012318 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current session. More
12319 information on how to use it at "http-request set-log-level".
12320
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012321 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to the
12322 client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-mark".
12323
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012324 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current session. More
12325 information on how to use it at "http-request set-nice".
12326
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012327 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
12328 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-tos".
12329
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012330 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012331 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12332 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012333
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012334 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12335 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012336 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012337 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12338 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012339 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012340 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012341 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012342 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12343 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012344 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012345 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12346 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012347
12348 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12349 followed by some converters.
12350
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012351 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012352 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12353 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12354 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12355 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12356 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12357 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012358 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012359 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12360 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12361
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012362 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12363
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012364 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12365 <var-name>.
12366
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012367 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12368 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12369 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12370 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12371 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12372
12373 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12374 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12375 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12376 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12377 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12378 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12379 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12380 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12381 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12382 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12383 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12384
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012385 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12386 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12387 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12388 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12389 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12390
12391 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12392
12393 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12394
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012395 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12396 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12397 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12398 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12399 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12400 evaluated.
12401
12402 Example:
12403 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12404
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012405 Example:
12406
12407 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012408 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012409
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012410 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012411 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012412 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012413 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12414 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012415 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012416 tcp-request content reject
12417
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012418 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12419 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12420 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12421 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12422 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12423 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12424 ...
12425 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12426
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012427 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012428 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12429 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12430 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012431 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012432
12433 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12434 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12435 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012436 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012437 tcp-request content reject
12438
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012439 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012440 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012441 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012442 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012443 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12444 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012445
12446 Example:
12447 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12448 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012449 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012450
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012451 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012452 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012453
12454 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012455 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012456 # protecting all our sites
12457 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012458 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12459 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012460 ...
12461 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12462
12463 backend http_dynamic
12464 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012465 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012466 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012467 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012468 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012469 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012470 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012472 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012473
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012474 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12475 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012476
12477
12478tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12479 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012481 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012482 Arguments :
12483 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12484 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12485 as explained at the top of this document.
12486
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012487 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012488 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12489 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12490 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12491 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12492
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012493 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12494 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12495 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12496 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12497
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012498 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012499 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012500 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012501 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012502 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012503 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12504 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12505 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012506
12507 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12508 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12509 it pass through unaffected.
12510
12511 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12512 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12513 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012514 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012515 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12516 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012517 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12518 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12519 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012520
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012521 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012522 "timeout client".
12523
12524
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012525tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12526 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12528 no | no | yes | yes
12529 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012530 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12531 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012532
12533 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12534
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012535 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012536 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12537 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012538 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12539 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012540
12541 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12542
12543 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12544 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12545 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12546 inserted.
12547
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012548 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012549 - accept :
12550 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12551 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12552 the rules evaluation.
12553
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012554 - close :
12555 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12556 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12557 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12558 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12559 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12560 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012561 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012562 protocols.
12563
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012564 - reject :
12565 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12566 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012567 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012568
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012569 - set-log-level <level>
12570 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current
12571 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12572 set-log-level".
12573
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012574 - set-mark <mark>
12575 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to
12576 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12577 set-mark".
12578
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012579 - set-nice <nice>
12580 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current
12581 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12582 set-nice".
12583
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012584 - set-tos <tos>
12585 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets
12586 sent to the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12587 set-tos".
12588
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012589 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12590 Sets a variable.
12591
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012592 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12593 Unsets a variable.
12594
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012595 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12596 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12597 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12598 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12599 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12600 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12601 no GPC stored at this index.
12602 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12603 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12604 data_types).
12605
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012606 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12607 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12608 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12609 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12610
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012611 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12612 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12613 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12614 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12615
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012616 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12617 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12618 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12619 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12620 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12621 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12622 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12623 no GPT stored at this index.
12624 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12625 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12626
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012627 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12628 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12629 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12630 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12631 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012632
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012633 - "silent-drop" :
12634 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012635 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012636 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12637 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12638 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12639 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12640 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012641 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12642 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012643 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12644 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012645 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012646 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12647 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12648 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12649 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12650
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012651 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12652 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12653
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012654 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12655 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12656 for changing the default action to a reject.
12657
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012658 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12659 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12660 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12661 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012662 period.
12663
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012664 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12665 declared inline.
12666
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012667 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12668 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012669 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012670 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12671 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012672 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012673 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012674 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012675 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12676 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012677 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012678 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12679 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012680
12681 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12682 followed by some converters.
12683
12684 Example:
12685
12686 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12687
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012688 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12689 <var-name>.
12690
12691 Example:
12692
12693 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12694
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012695 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12696 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12697 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12698 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12699 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12700
12701 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12702
12703 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12704
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012705 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12706
12707 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12708
12709
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012710tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12711 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12713 no | yes | yes | no
12714 Arguments :
12715 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12716 below.
12717
12718 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12719
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012720 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012721 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12722 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12723 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12724 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12725 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12726 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12727 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012728 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012729 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12730 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12731 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12732 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12733 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12734 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12735 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12736 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12737 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12738 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12739 instead.
12740
12741 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12742 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12743 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12744 rules which may be inserted.
12745
12746 Several types of actions are supported :
12747 - accept : the request is accepted
12748 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12749 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012750 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012751 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012752 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012753 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012754 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012755 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet14aec6e2021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012756 - set-dst <expr>
12757 - set-dst-port <expr>
12758 - set-src <expr>
12759 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012760 - set-tos <tos>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012761 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012762 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012763 - silent-drop
12764
12765 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12766 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12767 sections for a complete description.
12768
12769 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12770 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12771 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12772
12773 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12774 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12775 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12776 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12777 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12778
12779 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12780 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12781
12782 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12783 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12784 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12785
12786 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12787 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12788 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12789
12790 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12791 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12792 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12793
12794 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12795 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12796 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12797
12798 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12799
12800 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12801
12802
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012803tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12804 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12806 no | no | yes | yes
12807 Arguments :
12808 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12809 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12810 as explained at the top of this document.
12811
12812 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12813
12814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012815timeout check <timeout>
12816 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12817 established.
12818
12819 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12820 yes | no | yes | yes
12821 Arguments:
12822 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12823 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12824 as explained at the top of this document.
12825
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012826 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012827 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012828 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012829 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012830 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12831 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12832 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012833
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012834 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012835 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12836
12837 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12838 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012839 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012840
12841 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12842 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12843 forget about it.
12844
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012845 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12846 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012847
12848
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012849timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012850 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12852 yes | yes | yes | no
12853 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012854 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012855 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12856 as explained at the top of this document.
12857
12858 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12859 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12860 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012861 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12862 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12863 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12864 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012865 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12866 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12867 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012868 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012869 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012870 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12871 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012872 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12873 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012874
12875 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12876 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12877 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12878 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012879 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012880 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12881
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012882 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012883
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012884 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012885
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012886
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012887timeout client-fin <timeout>
12888 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12890 yes | yes | yes | no
12891 Arguments :
12892 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12893 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12894 as explained at the top of this document.
12895
12896 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12897 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12898 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12899 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12900 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12901 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12902 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012903 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12904 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12905 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012906
12907 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12908 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12909 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12910
12911 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12912
12913
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012914timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012915 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12917 yes | no | yes | yes
12918 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012919 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012920 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12921 as explained at the top of this document.
12922
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012923 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012924 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012925 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012926 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012927 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12928 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012929
12930 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12931 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12932 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12933 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012934 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012935 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12936
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012937 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012938
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012939
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012940timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12941 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12943 yes | yes | yes | yes
12944 Arguments :
12945 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12946 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12947 as explained at the top of this document.
12948
12949 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12950 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12951 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12952 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12953 once the request has started to present itself.
12954
12955 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12956 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12957 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12958 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12959 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12960
12961 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12962 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12963 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12964 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12965
12966 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12967 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012968 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012969 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12970 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012971 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012972
12973 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12974 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12975 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12976 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12977
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012978 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12979 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012980 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12981
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012982 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12983
12984
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012985timeout http-request <timeout>
12986 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012988 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012989 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012990 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012991 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12992 as explained at the top of this document.
12993
12994 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12995 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12996 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12997 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12998 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12999 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13000 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013001 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13002 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13003 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13004 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013005 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013006 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13007 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013008
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013009 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13010 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13011 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13012 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13013 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013014 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013015
13016 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13017 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013018 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013019 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13020 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13021
13022 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013023 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13024 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13025 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013026
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013027 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013028 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013029
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013030
13031timeout queue <timeout>
13032 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13034 yes | no | yes | yes
13035 Arguments :
13036 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13037 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13038 as explained at the top of this document.
13039
13040 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13041 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13042 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13043 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13044 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13045
13046 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13047 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13048 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13049 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13050
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013051 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013052
13053
13054timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013055 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13057 yes | no | yes | yes
13058 Arguments :
13059 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13060 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13061 as explained at the top of this document.
13062
13063 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13064 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13065 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13066 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13067 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13068 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13069 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13070
13071 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13072 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13073 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13074 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13075 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013076 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013077 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013078 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13079 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013080 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13081 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013082
13083 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13084 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13085 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13086 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013087 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013088 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13089
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013090 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013091
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013092
13093timeout server-fin <timeout>
13094 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13096 yes | no | yes | yes
13097 Arguments :
13098 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13099 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13100 as explained at the top of this document.
13101
13102 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13103 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13104 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13105 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13106 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13107 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13108 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13109 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13110 situations, it should not be needed.
13111
13112 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13113 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13114 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13115
13116 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13117
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013118
13119timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013120 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13122 yes | yes | yes | yes
13123 Arguments :
13124 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13125 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13126 as explained at the top of this document.
13127
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013128 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13129 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13130 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013131
13132 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13133 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13134 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13135 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013136 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013137
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013138 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013139
13140
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013141timeout tunnel <timeout>
13142 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13144 yes | no | yes | yes
13145 Arguments :
13146 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13147 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13148 as explained at the top of this document.
13149
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013150 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013151 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13152 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13153 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013154 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13155 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013156 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13157 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13158 specified.
13159
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013160 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13161 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13162 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13163 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13164 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13165 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13166 state.
13167
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013168 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13169 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13170 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13171 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013172 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013173
13174 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13175 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13176 forget about it.
13177
13178 Example :
13179 defaults http
13180 option http-server-close
13181 timeout connect 5s
13182 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013183 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013184 timeout server 30s
13185 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13186
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013187 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013188
13189
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013190transparent (deprecated)
13191 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013193 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013194 Arguments : none
13195
13196 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13197 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13198 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13199 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13200 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13201 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13202 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13203 appropriate server.
13204
13205 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13206
13207 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13208 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13209
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013210 See also: "option transparent"
13211
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013212unique-id-format <string>
13213 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13215 yes | yes | yes | no
13216 Arguments :
13217 <string> is a log-format string.
13218
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013219 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13220 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13221 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13222 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013223
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013224 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013225 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013226 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13227 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13228 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13229 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13230 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13231 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013232
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013233 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13234 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013235
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013236 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013237
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013238 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013239
13240 will generate:
13241
13242 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13243
13244 See also: "unique-id-header"
13245
13246unique-id-header <name>
13247 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13249 yes | yes | yes | no
13250 Arguments :
13251 <name> is the name of the header.
13252
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013253 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13254 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013255
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013256 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013257
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013258 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013259 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13260
13261 will generate:
13262
13263 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13264
13265 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013266
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013267use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013268 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13270 no | yes | yes | no
13271 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013272 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13273 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013274
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013275 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13276 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013277
13278 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13279 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13280 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013281 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013282 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013283 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13284 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013285
13286 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13287 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13288 assign the backend.
13289
13290 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13291 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13292 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13293 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13294 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13295 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13296
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013297 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013298 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013299 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13300 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13301 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13302
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013303 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13304 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13305 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13306 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13307 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13308 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13309 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13310 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13311 cannot be forced from the request.
13312
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013313 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013314 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13315 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13316
13317 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13318 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013319
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013320use-fcgi-app <name>
13321 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13323 no | no | yes | yes
13324 Arguments :
13325 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13326
13327 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013328
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013329use-server <server> if <condition>
13330use-server <server> unless <condition>
13331 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13333 no | no | yes | yes
13334 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013335 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13336 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013337
13338 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13339
13340 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13341 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13342 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13343
13344 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13345 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13346 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13347 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13348 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13349 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13350 matches will assign the server.
13351
13352 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13353 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13354 with the next rules until one matches.
13355
13356 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13357 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13358 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13359 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13360
13361 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13362 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13363 stripped.
13364
13365 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13366 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013367 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013368 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013369 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013370
13371 Example :
13372 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013373 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013374 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013375 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013376 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013377 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013378 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013379 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13380 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13381
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013382 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13383 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13384 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13385 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013386 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013387 and we fall back to load balancing.
13388
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013389 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013391
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133925. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013393--------------------------
13394
13395The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13396depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13397settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13398written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13399described in this section.
13400
13401
134025.1. Bind options
13403-----------------
13404
13405The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13406as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13407no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13408parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13409while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13410provided immediately after the setting name.
13411
13412The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13413
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013414accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13415 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13416 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13417 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13418 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13419 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13420 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13421 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13422 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13423 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013424 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13425 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13426 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013427
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013428accept-proxy
13429 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013430 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13431 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013432 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13433 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13434 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13435 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013436 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013437 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13438 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013439 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13440 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013441
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013442allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013443 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013444 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013445 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013446 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13447 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013448
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013449alpn <protocols>
13450 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13451 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13452 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013453 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013454 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013455 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13456 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13457 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13458 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13459 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13460 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13461 preference, like below :
13462
13463 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013464
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013465backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013466 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013467 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13468
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013469curves <curves>
13470 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13471 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13472 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13473 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13474 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13475 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13476
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013477ecdhe <named curve>
13478 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013479 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13480 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013481
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013482ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13484 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13485 client's certificate.
13486
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013487ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13489 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13490 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13491 error is ignored.
13492
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013493ca-sign-file <cafile>
13494 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13495 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13496 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13497 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13498 'generate-certificates' for details.
13499
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013500ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013501 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13502 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13503 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13504 'generate-certificates' for details.
13505
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013506ca-verify-file <cafile>
13507 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13508 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13509 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13510 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13511 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13512
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013513ciphers <ciphers>
13514 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13515 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013516 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013517 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013518 information and recommendations see e.g.
13519 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13520 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13521 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13522
13523ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13525 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13526 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13527 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013528 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13529 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013530
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013531crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13533 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013534 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13535 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013536
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013537crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013538 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13539 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13540 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13541 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13542 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013543 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13544 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013545
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013546 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13547 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13548
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013549 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13550 are loaded.
13551
13552 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013553 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13554 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13555 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13556 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13557 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13558 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13559 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013560 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013561
13562 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13563 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13564 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13565 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013566 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13567 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013568
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013569 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013570
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013571 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013572 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013573 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13574 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013575 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13576 clients).
13577
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013578 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013579 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13580 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13581 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13582 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13583 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13584 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13585 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13586 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13587 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13588 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13589 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13590 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13591
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013592 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013593 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13594 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13595 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13596 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13597
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013598 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13599 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13600 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13601 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013602
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013603 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13604 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13605 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013606
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013607crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013609 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013610 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013611 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013612
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013613crt-list <file>
13614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013615 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13616 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013617
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013618 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13619
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013620 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13621 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13622 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13623 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13624 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013625
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013626 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013627 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13628 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13629 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13630 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13631 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013632 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13633 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13634 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013635
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013636 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13637 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13638 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013639
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013640 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13641
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013642 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013643 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013644 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13645 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13646 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13647 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13648 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13649 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013650
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013651 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013652 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013653 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013654 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013655 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013656 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013657
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013658defer-accept
13659 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13660 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13661 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013662 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013663 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13664 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13665 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13666 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13667 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13668 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13669 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13670
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013671expose-fd listeners
13672 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13673 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013674 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13675 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013676 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013677
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013678force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013679 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013680 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013681 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013682 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013683
13684force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013685 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013686 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013687 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013688
13689force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013690 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013691 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013692 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013693
13694force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013695 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013696 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013697 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013698
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013699force-tlsv13
13700 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13701 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013702 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013703
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013704generate-certificates
13705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13706 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13707 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13708 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13709 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13710 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13711 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13712 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13713 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13714 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13715 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13716
13717 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13718 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013719 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013720 certificate is used many times.
13721
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013722gid <gid>
13723 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13724 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13725 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13726 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13727 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13728
13729group <group>
13730 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13731 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13732 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13733 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13734 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13735
13736id <id>
13737 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13738 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13739 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13740 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13741
13742interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013743 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13744 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13745 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13746 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13747 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13748 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013749 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13750 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13751 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13752 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13753 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13754 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013755
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013756level <level>
13757 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13758 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13759 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013760 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013761 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13762 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13763 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013764 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013765 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013766 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013767 all counters).
13768
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013769severity-output <format>
13770 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13771 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13772 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13773 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13774 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13775 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13776 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13777 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13778 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13779 rfc5424 convention.
13780
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013781maxconn <maxconn>
13782 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13783 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13784 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13785 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13786 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13787 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13788 eat all memory.
13789
13790mode <mode>
13791 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13792 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13793 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13794 UNIX sockets.
13795
13796mss <maxseg>
13797 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13798 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13799 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13800 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13801 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13802 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13803 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13804 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13805 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13806 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13807 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13808
13809name <name>
13810 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13811 page.
13812
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013813namespace <name>
13814 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13815 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13816 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13817 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13818
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013819nice <nice>
13820 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13821 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13822 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13823 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13824 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13825 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13826 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13827 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13828 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13829 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13830 one for an RDP socket.
13831
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013832no-ca-names
13833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13834 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013835 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013836
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013837no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013838 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013839 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013840 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013841 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013842 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13843 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013844
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013845no-tls-tickets
13846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13847 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13848 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013849 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13850 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013851 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13852 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13853 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013854
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013855no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013857 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013858 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013859 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013860 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13861 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013862
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013863no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013865 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013866 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013867 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013868 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13869 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013870
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013871no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013873 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013874 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013875 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013876 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13877 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013878
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013879no-tlsv13
13880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13881 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13882 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13883 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013884 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13885 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013886
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013887npn <protocols>
13888 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13889 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13890 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013891 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013892 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013893 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13894 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13895 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13896 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13897 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013898
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013899prefer-client-ciphers
13900 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13901 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13902 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013903 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13904 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13905 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013906
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013907process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013908 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
13909 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
13910 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
13911 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
13912 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
13913 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013914
13915 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13916
13917 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013918 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
13919 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
13920 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
13921 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
13922 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013923
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013924proto <name>
13925 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13926 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13927 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013928 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13929 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13930
13931 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13932 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13933 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13934 also reported (flag=HTX).
13935
13936 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13937 a bind line :
13938
13939 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13940 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13941 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13942
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013943 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013944 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013945 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013946 h2" on the bind line.
13947
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013948ssl
13949 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013950 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013951 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13952 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013953 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13954 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013955
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013956ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13957 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013958 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13959 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13960 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013961 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13962
13963ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013964 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13965 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13966 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13967 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013968
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013969strict-sni
13970 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13971 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13972 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13973 See the "crt" option for more information.
13974
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013975tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013976 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013977 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013978 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013979 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013980 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13981 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13982 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13983 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13984 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13985 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13986 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13987
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013988tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013989 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013990 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13991 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13992 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13993 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13994 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13995 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13996 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013997 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13998 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13999 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014000
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014001tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14002 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014003 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14004 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14005 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14006 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14007 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14008 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14009 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14010 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14011 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14012 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014013 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14014 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14015
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014016transparent
14017 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14018 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14019 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14020 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14021 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14022 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14023 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14024 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14025 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14026 so check for support with your vendor.
14027
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014028v4v6
14029 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14030 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14031 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14032 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014033 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014034
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014035v6only
14036 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14037 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14038 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014039 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14040 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014041
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014042uid <uid>
14043 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14044 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14045 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14046 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14047 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14048
14049user <user>
14050 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14051 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14052 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14053 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14054 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14055
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014056verify [none|optional|required]
14057 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14058 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14059 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14060 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14061 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014062 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14063 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14064 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14065 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014066
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140675.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014068------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014069
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014070The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14071which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14072arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14073settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14074after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14075Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14076address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014078 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014079 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014080
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014081Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14082keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014084The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014085
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014086addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014087 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014088 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14089 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14090 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14091 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14092 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014093
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014094agent-check
14095 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014096 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014097 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14098 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14099 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014100
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014101 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014102 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014103 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014104 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14105 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014106
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014107 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14108 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14109 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14110 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14111 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014112
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014113 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014114 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014115
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014116 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14117 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14118 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014119
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014120 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14121 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14122 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014123
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014124 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014125 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14126 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14127 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14128 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014129 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014130 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014131
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014132 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14133 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014134
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014135 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14136 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14137 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14138 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14139 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14140 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14141 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14142 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14143 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014144
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014145 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14146 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014147 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14148 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14149 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014150 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014151
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014152 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014153 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014154
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014155agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014156 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014157 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14158 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14159 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14160 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14161
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014162agent-inter <delay>
14163 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14164 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14165
14166 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14167 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14168 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14169 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14170 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14171 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14172 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14173 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14174 of backends use the same servers.
14175
14176 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14177
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014178agent-addr <addr>
14179 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14180
14181 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014182 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014183 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14184 hostname, it will be resolved.
14185
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014186agent-port <port>
14187 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14188
14189 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14190
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014191allow-0rtt
14192 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014193 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14194 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014195
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014196alpn <protocols>
14197 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14198 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14199 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014200 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014201 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14202 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14203 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14204 now obsolete NPN extension.
14205 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14206 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14207
14208 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014210backup
14211 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14212 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14213 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14214 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014215 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14216 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014217
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014218ca-file <cafile>
14219 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14220 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14221 server's certificate.
14222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014223check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014224 This option enables health checks on a server:
14225 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14226 considered available.
14227 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14228 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14229 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14230 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14231 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14232 set.
14233 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14234 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14235 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14236 exchanges succeed.
14237
14238 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14239 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14240 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14241 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14242 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014243 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014244 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14245
14246 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14247 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14248
14249 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14250 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14251
14252 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14253 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14254 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14255 available.
14256
14257 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14258 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14259 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14260
14261 Example:
14262 # simple tcp check
14263 backend foo
14264 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14265 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14266 backend foo
14267 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14268 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14269 backend foo
14270 option tcp-check
14271 tcp-check connect
14272 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014273
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014274check-send-proxy
14275 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14276 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14277 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14278 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14279 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14280 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14281 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14282
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014283check-alpn <protocols>
14284 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14285 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14286 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14287
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014288check-proto <name>
14289 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14290 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14291 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014292 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14293 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14294
14295 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14296 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14297 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14298 also reported (flag=HTX).
14299
14300 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14301 directive on a server line:
14302
14303 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14304 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14305 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14306 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14307
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014308 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014309 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14310 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14311
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014312check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014313 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014314 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14315 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014316
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014317check-ssl
14318 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14319 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14320 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14321 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014322 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014323 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14324 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014325 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014326 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14327 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014328
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014329check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014330 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014331 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14332 for normal traffic.
14333
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014334ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14336 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14337 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014338 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14339 information and recommendations see e.g.
14340 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14341 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14342 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014343
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014344ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14346 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14347 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14348 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014349 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14350 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14351 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014353cookie <value>
14354 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14355 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14356 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14357 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14358 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14359 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14360 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14361
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014362crl-file <crlfile>
14363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14364 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14365 to verify server's certificate.
14366
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014367crt <cert>
14368 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14369 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14370 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14371 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14372 certificate request.
14373
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014374 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14375 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14376 option is set accordingly).
14377
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014378disabled
14379 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14380 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14381 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14382 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14383 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014384 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014385
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014386enabled
14387 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14388 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14389 default value.
14390 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14391 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014393error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014394 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14395 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14396 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014398 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014400fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014401 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14402 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14403 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14404
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014405force-sslv3
14406 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14407 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014408 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014409 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014410
14411force-tlsv10
14412 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014413 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014414 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014415
14416force-tlsv11
14417 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014418 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014419 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014420
14421force-tlsv12
14422 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014423 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014424 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014425
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014426force-tlsv13
14427 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14428 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014429 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014431id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014432 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14433 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14434 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014435
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014436init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14437 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14438 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014439 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014440 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14441 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14442 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14443 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14444 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14445 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14446 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14447 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14448 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014449 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014450 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14451 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14452 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14453 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14454 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14455 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014456 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014457
14458 Example:
14459 defaults
14460 # never fail on address resolution
14461 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014463inter <delay>
14464fastinter <delay>
14465downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014466 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14467 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14468 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14469 between checks depending on the server state :
14470
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014471 Server state | Interval used
14472 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14473 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14474 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14475 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14476 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14477 or yet unchecked. |
14478 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14479 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14480 | "inter" otherwise.
14481 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014483 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14484 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14485 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14486 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014487 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14488 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14489 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14490 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14491 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014492
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014493log-proto <logproto>
14494 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14495 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14496 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14497 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014499maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014500 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14501 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014502 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14503 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014504 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14505 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14506 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14507 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14508
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014509 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14510 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14511 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14512 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14513 than 50 concurrent requests.
14514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014515maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014516 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14517 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14518 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14519 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014520 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14521 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14522 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14523 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14524 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14525 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14526 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014527
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014528max-reuse <count>
14529 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14530 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14531 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14532 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14533 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14534 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14535 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14536 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014538minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014539 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14540 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14541 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14542 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14543 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14544 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014545 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014546 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014547
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014548namespace <name>
14549 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14550 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14551 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14552 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14553
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014554no-agent-check
14555 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14556 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14557 default value.
14558 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14559 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14560
14561no-backup
14562 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14563 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14564 default value.
14565 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14566 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14567
14568no-check
14569 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14570 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14571 default value.
14572 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14573 "default-server" "check" setting.
14574
14575no-check-ssl
14576 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14577 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14578 default value.
14579 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14580 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14581
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014582no-send-proxy
14583 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14584 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14585 default value.
14586 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14587 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14588
14589no-send-proxy-v2
14590 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14591 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14592 default value.
14593 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14594 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14595
14596no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14597 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14598 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14599 default value.
14600 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14601 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14602
14603no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14604 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14605 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14606 default value.
14607 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14608 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14609
14610no-ssl
14611 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14612 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14613 default value.
14614 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14615 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14616
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014617 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14618 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14619 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14620
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014621no-ssl-reuse
14622 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14623 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14624 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14625 and for paranoid users.
14626
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014627no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014628 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14629 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014630 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014631
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014632 Supported in default-server: No
14633
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014634no-tls-tickets
14635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14636 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14637 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014638 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14639 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014640 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14641 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14642 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014643 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014644
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014645no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014646 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014647 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14648 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014649 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14650 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014651 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014652
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014653 Supported in default-server: No
14654
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014655no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014656 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014657 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14658 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014659 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14660 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014661 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014662
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014663 Supported in default-server: No
14664
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014665no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014666 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014667 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14668 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014669 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14670 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014671 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014672
14673 Supported in default-server: No
14674
14675no-tlsv13
14676 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14677 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14678 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14679 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14680 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014681 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014682
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014683 Supported in default-server: No
14684
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014685no-verifyhost
14686 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14687 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14688 default value.
14689 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14690 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014691
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014692no-tfo
14693 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14694 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14695 default value.
14696 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14697 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14698
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014699non-stick
14700 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14701 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14702 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14703
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014704npn <protocols>
14705 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14706 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14707 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014708 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014709 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14710 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14711 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14712
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014713observe <mode>
14714 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14715 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14716 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14717 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14718 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14719 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014720 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014721
14722 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014724on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014725 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14726 Currently, four modes are available:
14727 - fastinter: force fastinter
14728 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14729 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14730 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14731 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14732
14733 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14734
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014735on-marked-down <action>
14736 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14737 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014738 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14739 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14740 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14741 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14742 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14743 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14744 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14745 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014746
14747 Actions are disabled by default
14748
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014749on-marked-up <action>
14750 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14751 Currently one action is available:
14752 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14753 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14754 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14755 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014756 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14757 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014758 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14759 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14760
14761 Actions are disabled by default
14762
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014763pool-low-conn <max>
14764 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14765 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14766 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14767 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14768 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14769 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14770 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14771 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14772 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14773 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014774 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14775 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14776 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14777 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014778
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014779pool-max-conn <max>
14780 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14781 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14782 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14783 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14784 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14785 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14786
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014787pool-purge-delay <delay>
14788 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014789 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014790 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014792port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014793 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014794 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14795 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14796 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14797 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14798 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014799
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014800proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014801 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14802 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14803 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014804 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14805 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14806
14807 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14808 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14809 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14810 also reported (flag=HTX).
14811
14812 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14813 a server line :
14814
14815 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14816 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14817 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14818 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14819
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014820 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014821 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014823redir <prefix>
14824 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14825 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14826 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14827 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14828 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14829 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14830 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14831 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014832 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014833 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014834 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14835 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14836 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14837 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14838
14839 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014841rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014842 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14843 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14844 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14845
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014846resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14847 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14848 server.
14849
14850 Available options:
14851
14852 * allow-dup-ip
14853 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14854 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14855 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14856 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14857 For such case, simply enable this option.
14858 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14859
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014860 * ignore-weight
14861 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14862 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14863 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14864
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014865 * prevent-dup-ip
14866 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14867 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14868 same fqdn.
14869 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14870
14871 Example:
14872 backend b_myapp
14873 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14874 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14875 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14876
14877 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14878 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14879 it
14880 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14881 different address
14882
14883 Default value: not set
14884
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014885resolve-prefer <family>
14886 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14887 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14888 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14889 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14890
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014891 Default value: ipv6
14892
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014893 Example:
14894
14895 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014896
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014897resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014898 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014899 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014900 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014901 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14902 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014903 configured network, another address is selected.
14904
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014905 Example:
14906
14907 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014908
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014909resolvers <id>
14910 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14911 hostname.
14912
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014913 Example:
14914
14915 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014916
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014917 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014918
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014919send-proxy
14920 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14921 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14922 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14923 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014924 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14925 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14926 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14927 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014928 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014929 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14930 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14931 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14932 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14933 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014934 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14935 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014936
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014937send-proxy-v2
14938 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14939 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14940 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14941 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014942 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14943 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14944 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14945 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014946
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014947proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014948 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14949 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14950
14951 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14952 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14953 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14954 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14955 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14956 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14957 connection is supported).
14958 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14959 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14960 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14961 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14962 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14963 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14964 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014965
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014966send-proxy-v2-ssl
14967 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14968 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14969 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14970 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14971 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14972 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14973 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014974 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14975 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014976
14977send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14978 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14979 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14980 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14981 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14982 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14983 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14984 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14985 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014986 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14987 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014989slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014990 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14991 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14992 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14993 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14994 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14995 parameters :
14996
14997 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14998 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14999
15000 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15001 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15002 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15003 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15004
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015005 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015006 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15007 seen as failed.
15008
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015009sni <expression>
15010 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15011 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15012 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15013 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015014 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15015 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015016 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015017 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15018 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015019
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015020source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015021source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015022source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015023 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15024 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15025 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15026 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15027
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015028 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15029 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15030 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15031 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15032 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15033 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15034 server.
15035
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015036 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15037 specifying the source address without port(s).
15038
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015039ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015040 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15041 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15042 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15043 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15044 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15045 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015046 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15047 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015048
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015049ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15050 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15051 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15052 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15053
15054ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15055 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15056 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15057 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15058
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015059ssl-reuse
15060 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15061 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15062 default value.
15063 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15064 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15065
15066stick
15067 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15068 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15069 default value.
15070 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15071 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015072
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015073socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015074 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015075 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15076 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15077
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015078tcp-ut <delay>
15079 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015080 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015081 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015082 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015083 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15084 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15085 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15086 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15087 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15088 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15089 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15090 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15091 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15092
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015093tfo
15094 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15095 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15096 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15097 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015098 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015099 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015101track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015102 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15103 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15104 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15105 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015106 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15107
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015108tls-tickets
15109 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15110 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15111 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015112 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15113 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15114 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015115 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015116 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015117
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015118verify [none|required]
15119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015120 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015121 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15122 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015123 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015124 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15125 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15126 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15127 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15128 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15129 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15130 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15131 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015132
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015133verifyhost <hostname>
15134 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015135 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15136 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15137 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15138 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15139 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15140 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15141 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15142 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015144weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015145 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15146 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15147 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015148 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15149 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15150 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15151 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15152 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15153 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015154
15155
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151565.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15157-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015158
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015159HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15160using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015161configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015162This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15163can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15164workload.
15165This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15166resolution at run time.
15167Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15168carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15169
15170
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151715.3.1. Global overview
15172----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015173
15174As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15175different steps of the process life:
15176
15177 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15178 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15179 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15180
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015181 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15182 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015183
15184A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15185 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15186 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15187 resolution to know this new IP.
15188
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015189When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015190HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015191SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15192from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015193will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015194will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015195
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015196A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015197 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015198 first valid response.
15199
15200 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15201 servers return an error.
15202
15203
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152045.3.2. The resolvers section
15205----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015206
15207This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015208HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15209contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015210
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015211When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15212uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15213is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15214answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15215
15216When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015217used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015218
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015219 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15220 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15221 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015222
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015223 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15224 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015225
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015226 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15227 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15228 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015229
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015230For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15231following scenarios are possible:
15232
15233 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15234 ignored
15235
15236 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15237 applied
15238
15239 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15240 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15241
15242 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15243 retries the query with a new type
15244
15245 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15246 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015247
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015248As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015249a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015250<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015251
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015252
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015253resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015254 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015255
15256A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15257
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015258accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015259 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015260 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015261 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15262 by RFC 6891)
15263
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015264 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15265 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15266 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15267 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15268 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15269 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015270
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015271nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15272 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15273 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15274 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15275 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15276 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15277 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15278 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15279 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15280 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015281 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15282
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015283parse-resolv-conf
15284 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15285 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15286 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15287
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015288hold <status> <period>
15289 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15290 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015291 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015292 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015293 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15294 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15295 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15296
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015297 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015298
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015299resolve_retries <nb>
15300 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15301 giving up.
15302 Default value: 3
15303
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015304 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15305 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15306 type.
15307
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015308timeout <event> <time>
15309 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15310 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15311 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015312 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15313 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015314 Default value: 1s
15315 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015316 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015317 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015318 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15319 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15320
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015321 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015322
15323 resolvers mydns
15324 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15325 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015326 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015327 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015328 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015329 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015330 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015331 hold other 30s
15332 hold refused 30s
15333 hold nx 30s
15334 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015335 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015336 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015337
15338
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153396. Cache
15340---------
15341
15342HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15343(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15344RAM.
15345
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015346The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15347blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015348
15349If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15350independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15351when we try to allocate a new one.
15352
15353The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15354
15355It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15356"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15357for more details.
15358
15359When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15360replaced by "<CACHE>".
15361
15362
153636.1. Limitation
15364----------------
15365
15366The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15367
15368- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015369- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15370 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15371 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015372- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15373- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015374- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15375 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15376 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015377- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15378 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015379- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15380 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15381 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015382
15383- If the request is not a GET
15384- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15385- If the request contains an Authorization header
15386
15387
153886.2. Setup
15389-----------
15390
15391To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15392the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15393
15394
153956.2.1. Cache section
15396---------------------
15397
15398cache <name>
15399 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15400 size of cache is mandatory.
15401
15402total-max-size <megabytes>
15403 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15404 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15405
15406max-object-size <bytes>
15407 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15408 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15409 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15410
15411max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015412 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015413 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15414 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15415 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15416 default.
15417
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015418process-vary <on/off>
15419 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015420 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15421 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15422 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015423 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015424
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015425max-secondary-entries <number>
15426 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15427 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15428 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15429
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015430
154316.2.2. Proxy section
15432---------------------
15433
15434http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15435 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15436 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15437 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15438 after this one.
15439
15440http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15441 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15442 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15443 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15444 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15445
15446
15447Example:
15448
15449 backend bck1
15450 mode http
15451
15452 http-request cache-use foobar
15453 http-response cache-store foobar
15454 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15455
15456 cache foobar
15457 total-max-size 4
15458 max-age 240
15459
15460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154617. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15462----------------------------------
15463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015464HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015465client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15466The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15467these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15468but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15469data called patterns.
15470
15471
154727.1. ACL basics
15473---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015474
15475The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15476content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15477from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15478simple :
15479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015480 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015481 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15483 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015485The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15486adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015487
15488In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015491
15492This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15493Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15494and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015495an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15496conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15497as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15498are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015499
15500ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15501'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15502which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15503
15504There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15505performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15508specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15509this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015510methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15511ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512
15513Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15514 - boolean
15515 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15516 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15517 - string
15518 - data block
15519
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015520Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15521converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15522would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15523The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15524which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15525
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015526Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15527keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15528fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15529which are summarized in the table below :
15530
15531 +---------------------+-----------------+
15532 | Sample or converter | Default |
15533 | output type | matching method |
15534 +---------------------+-----------------+
15535 | boolean | bool |
15536 +---------------------+-----------------+
15537 | integer | int |
15538 +---------------------+-----------------+
15539 | ip | ip |
15540 +---------------------+-----------------+
15541 | string | str |
15542 +---------------------+-----------------+
15543 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15544 +---------------------+-----------------+
15545
15546Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15547matching method, see below.
15548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015549The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15550 - boolean
15551 - integer or integer range
15552 - IP address / network
15553 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15554 - regular expression
15555 - hex block
15556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015557The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15558
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015559 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15560 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015562 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015563 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015564 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015565 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15568read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15569if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15570lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15571will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15572beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015573a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15575exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15576
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015577The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15578parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15579ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15580a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15581check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15582
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015583The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15584socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15585file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15588loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15589
15590 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15591
15592In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15593the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15594case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15595as well.
15596
15597The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15598sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15599do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15600methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15601is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015602obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15604default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15605that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15606string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15607
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015608The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15609By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15610string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15611resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015612server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015613waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015614flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15615function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15618sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15619be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015620
15621 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15622 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15624 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15625 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15626 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015627
15628 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15629 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015631
15632 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015634
15635 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015637
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015638 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015639 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15640
15641 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15642 binary or string samples.
15643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015644 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15645 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15648 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15649 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15652 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15655 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15658 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15661 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015662 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15665 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15666 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015667
15668For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15669request, it is possible to do :
15670
15671 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15672
15673In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15674buffer, one would use the following acl :
15675
15676 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15677
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015678On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15679possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15680
15681 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15684criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15685method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15686to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15687criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15688the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015691the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15692For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15695 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15696 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15697 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015698
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015699
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015700The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15701types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15702combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15703brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15704default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706 +-------------------------------------------------+
15707 | Input sample type |
15708 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015709 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15711 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15712 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015713 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015715 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015717 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015719 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015721 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015723 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015725 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015727 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015729 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015731 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015733 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15735 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15736 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015737
15738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157397.1.1. Matching booleans
15740------------------------
15741
15742In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15743Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15744When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15745that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15746
15747Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15748return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15749"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15750
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157527.1.2. Matching integers
15753------------------------
15754
15755Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15756enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15757to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15758
15759Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15760matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15761lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015762
15763For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15764unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15765representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15766
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015767As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15768two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15769instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15770ranges and operators.
15771
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015772For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015773operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15774Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15775of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015776
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015777Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015778
15779 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15780 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15781 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15782 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15783 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15784
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015785For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015786
15787 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15788
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015789This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15790
15791 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15792
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157947.1.3. Matching strings
15795-----------------------
15796
15797String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15798different forms :
15799
15800 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015801 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015802
15803 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015804 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805
15806 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15807 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15808
15809 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15810 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15811
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015812 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15814 matches.
15815
15816 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15817 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15818 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015819
15820String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15821exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15822characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15823string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15824to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015825before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015826
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015827Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15828(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15829Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15830
15831Example:
15832 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15833 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15834
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158367.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15837---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015838
15839Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15840they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15841possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15842passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15843the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015844the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15845match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015846
15847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158487.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15849-------------------------------------
15850
15851It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15852not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15853a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15854to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15855digits may be used upper or lower case.
15856
15857Example :
15858 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15859 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15860
15861
158627.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15863---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015864
15865IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15866netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15867within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015868host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015869difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15870at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15871does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15872parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015873
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015874The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15875abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15876
15877 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15878 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15879 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15880 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15881 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15882 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15883 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15884 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15885
15886Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15887192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15888
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015889IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15890Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15891trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15892IPv6 patterns.
15893
15894HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15895following situations :
15896 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15897 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15898 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15899 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15900 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15901 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15902 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15903 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15904 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15905 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015907
159087.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15909----------------------------------
15910
15911Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15912combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15913
15914 - AND (implicit)
15915 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15916 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15923indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15926"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15927requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15928is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15929
15930 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015931 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15932 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15933 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934
15935To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15936and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15937
15938 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15939 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15940 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15941 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15942
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015943 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15945 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15946 use_backend www if host_www
15947
15948It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15949expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15950be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15951the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15952
15953 The following rule :
15954
15955 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015956 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957
15958 Can also be written that way :
15959
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015960 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015961
15962It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15963to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15964simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15965sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15966good use is the following :
15967
15968 With named ACLs :
15969
15970 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15971 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15972 monitor fail if site_dead
15973
15974 With anonymous ACLs :
15975
15976 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15977
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015978See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15979keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015980
15981
159827.3. Fetching samples
15983---------------------
15984
15985Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15986against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15987sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15988ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15989of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15990available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15991
15992This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15993Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15994compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15995deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15996
15997The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15998matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15999method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16000indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16001
16002As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16003when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16004mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16005the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16006ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16007
16008Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16009multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16010when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016011incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16012are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016013is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16014all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16015
16016Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16017 - name
16018 - name(arg1)
16019 - name(arg1,arg2)
16020
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016021
160227.3.1. Converters
16023-----------------
16024
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016025Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16026of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16027is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16028was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016029has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016030unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16031
16032These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16033sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16034the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016035support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016036
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016037A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16038support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16039supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16040(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16041bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016044
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001604551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16046 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16047 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16048 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16049 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16050 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16051
16052 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016053 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16054 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016055 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16056 frontend http-in
16057 bind *:8081
16058 default_backend servers
16059 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16060 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16061
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016062add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016063 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016064 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016065 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16066 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016067 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016068 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16069 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16070 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16071 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016072 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016073 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016074
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016075aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16076 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16077 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16078 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16079 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16080 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16081 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16082
16083 Example:
16084 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16085 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16086
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016087and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016088 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016089 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016090 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16091 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016092 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016093 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16094 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16095 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16096 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016097 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016098 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016099
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016100b64dec
16101 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16102 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016103 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16104 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016105
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016106base64
16107 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016108 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016109 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16110 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016111
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016112be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16113 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16114 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16115 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16116 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16117 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16118
16119 Example:
16120 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16121 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16122 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16123 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16124
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016125be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16126 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16127 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16128 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16129 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16130 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16131 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16132
16133 Example:
16134 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16135 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16136 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16137 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16138
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016139bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016140 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016141 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016142 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016143 presence of a flag).
16144
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016145bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16146 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16147 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016148 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016149
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016150concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16151 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16152 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16153 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16154 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16155 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16156 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16157 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16158 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16159 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16160 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016161 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016162 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016163 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16164 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016165
16166 Example:
16167 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16168 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16169 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016170 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016171 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16172
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016173cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016174 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16175 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016176
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016177crc32([<avalanche>])
16178 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16179 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16180 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16181 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16182 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16183 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16184 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16185 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16186 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16187 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016188 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16189
16190crc32c([<avalanche>])
16191 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16192 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16193 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16194 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16195 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16196 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16197 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16198 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016199
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016200cut_crlf
16201 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16202 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16203 updated.
16204
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016205da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016206 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16207 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16208 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16209 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016210 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016211 configuration language.
16212
16213 Example:
16214 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016215 bind *:8881
16216 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016217 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016218
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016219debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16220 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16221 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16222 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16223 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16224 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16225 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16226 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16227 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16228 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16229 printable sample types.
16230
16231 Example:
16232 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016233
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016234digest(<algorithm>)
16235 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16236 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16237
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016238 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016239 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16240
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016241div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016242 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16243 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016244 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016245 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16246 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016247 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016248 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16249 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16250 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16251 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016252 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016253 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016254
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016255djb2([<avalanche>])
16256 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16257 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16258 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16259 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16260 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16261 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16262 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016263 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16264 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016265
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016266even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016267 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016268 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16269
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016270field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16271 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16272 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16273 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16274 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16275 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16276 fields.
16277
16278 Example :
16279 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16280 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16281 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16282 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16283 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016284
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016285fix_is_valid
16286 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16287 Information eXchange):
16288
16289 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16290 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016291 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016292 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016293 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016294 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16295 checksum
16296
16297 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16298 the server can be parsed.
16299
16300 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16301 message, false if not.
16302
16303 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16304
16305 Example:
16306 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16307 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16308
16309fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16310 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16311 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16312 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16313 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016314 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016315 added.
16316
16317 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16318 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16319 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16320 fix_is_valid converter.
16321
16322 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16323
16324 Example:
16325 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16326 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16327 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16328 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16329 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16330
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016331hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016332 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016333 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016334 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016335 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016336
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016337hex2i
16338 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016339 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016340
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016341htonl
16342 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16343 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16344 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16345 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16346
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016347hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016348 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16349 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16350 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16351 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16352
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016353 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016354 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16355
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016356http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016357 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16358 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016359 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16360 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16361 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16362 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16363 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16364 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16365 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16366 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016367
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016368iif(<true>,<false>)
16369 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16370 string otherwise.
16371
16372 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016373 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016374
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016375in_table(<table>)
16376 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16377 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16378 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016379 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016380 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16381
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016382ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016383 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016384 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016385 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16386 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16387 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16388 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16389 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016390
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016391json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016392 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016393 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016394 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016395 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16396 of errors:
16397 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16398 bytes, ...)
16399 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16400 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16401
16402 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16403 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16404 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16405 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16406 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16407 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016408 - "ascii" : never fails;
16409 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16410 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016411 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016412 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016413 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16414 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16415
16416 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016417 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016418
16419 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016420 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016421 capture request header user-agent len 150
16422 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016423
16424 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16425 GET / HTTP/1.0
16426 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16427
16428 Output log:
16429 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16430
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016431json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16432 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16433 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16434 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16435 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16436
16437 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16438 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16439
16440 Example:
16441 # get a integer value from the request body
16442 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16443 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16444
16445 # get a key with '.' in the name
16446 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16447 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16448
16449 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16450 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16451
16452 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16453 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16454
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016455language(<value>[,<default>])
16456 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16457 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16458 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16459 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16460 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16461 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16462 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16463 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16464 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016465 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016466 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16467 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016468
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016469 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016470
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016471 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16472 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016473
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016474 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16475 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16476 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16477 use_backend spanish if es
16478 use_backend french if fr
16479 use_backend english if en
16480 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016481
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016482length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016483 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16484 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16485 type. The result is of type integer.
16486
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016487lower
16488 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16489 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16490 type. The result is of type string.
16491
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016492ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16493 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16494 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16495 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16496 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16497 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16498 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16499
16500 Example :
16501
16502 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016503 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016504 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16505
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016506ltrim(<chars>)
16507 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16508 representation of the input sample.
16509
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016510map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16511map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16512map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16513 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16514 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16515 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16516 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16517 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16518 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16519 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16520 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016521
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016522 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16523 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16524 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016525
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016526 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016527 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016528
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016529 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16530 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16531 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16532 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016533 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16534 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016535 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16536 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16537 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16538 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16539 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16540 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16541 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16542 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016543 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16544 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16545 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016546 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16547 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16548 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16549 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16550 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016551
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016552 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16553 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16554 the corresponding match text.
16555
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016556 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16557 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16558 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16559 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16560 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016561
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016562 Example :
16563
16564 # this is a comment and is ignored
16565 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16566 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16567 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16568 | | | `---------- value
16569 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16570 | `---------------------------- key
16571 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16572
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016573mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016574 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16575 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016576 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016577 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016578 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016579 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16580 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16581 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16582 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016583 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016584 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016585
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016586mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016587 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16588 <packettype>.
16589 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16590 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16591 from.
16592 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16593 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16594 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16595
16596 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16597 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16598 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16599 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16600
16601 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16602 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16603 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16604 packets only):
16605 17: Session Expiry Interval
16606 33: Receive Maximum
16607 39: Maximum Packet Size
16608 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16609 25: Request Response Information
16610 23: Request Problem Information
16611 21: Authentication Method
16612 22: Authentication Data
16613 18: Will Delay Interval
16614 1: Payload Format Indicator
16615 2: Message Expiry Interval
16616 3: Content Type
16617 8: Response Topic
16618 9: Correlation Data
16619 Not supported yet:
16620 38: User Property
16621
16622 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16623 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16624 packets only):
16625 17: Session Expiry Interval
16626 33: Receive Maximum
16627 36: Maximum QoS
16628 37: Retain Available
16629 39: Maximum Packet Size
16630 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16631 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16632 31: Reason String
16633 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16634 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16635 42: Shared Subscription Available
16636 19: Server Keep Alive
16637 26: Response Information
16638 28: Server Reference
16639 21: Authentication Method
16640 22: Authentication Data
16641 Not supported yet:
16642 38: User Property
16643
16644 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16645 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16646 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16647 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16648
16649 Example:
16650
16651 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16652 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16653 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16654 if data_in_buffer
16655 # do the same as above
16656 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16657 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16658 if data_in_buffer
16659
16660mqtt_is_valid
16661 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16662
16663 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16664 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16665 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16666 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16667
16668 Example:
16669
16670 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016671 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016672
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016673mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016674 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016675 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16676 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016677 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016678 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016679 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016680 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16681 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16682 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16683 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016684 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016685 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016686
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016687nbsrv
16688 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16689 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16690 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16691 map lookup.
16692
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016693neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016694 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16695 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16696 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16697 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016698
16699not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016700 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016701 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016702 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016703 absence of a flag).
16704
16705odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016706 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016707 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16708
16709or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016710 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016711 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016712 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16713 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016714 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016715 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16716 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16717 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16718 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016719 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016720 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016721
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016722protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16723 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16724 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16725 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16726 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16727 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16728 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16729 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16730 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16731 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16732 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16733 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16734
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016735regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016736 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16737 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16738 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16739 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16740 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16741 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16742 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16743 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16744 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016745 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16746 of characters with other ones.
16747
16748 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16749 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16750 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16751 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16752 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16753 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016754
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016755 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016756
16757 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16758 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16759 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016760 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016761
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016762 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16763 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16764
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016765 # capture groups and backreferences
16766 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016767 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016768 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16769
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016770capture-req(<id>)
16771 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16772 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16773
16774 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016775 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16776 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016777
16778capture-res(<id>)
16779 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16780 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16781
16782 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016783 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16784 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016785
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016786rtrim(<chars>)
16787 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16788 of the input sample.
16789
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016790sdbm([<avalanche>])
16791 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16792 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16793 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16794 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16795 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16796 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16797 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016798 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16799 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016800
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016801secure_memcmp(<var>)
16802 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16803 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16804 match.
16805
16806 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16807 performed in constant time.
16808
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016809 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016810 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16811
16812 Example :
16813
16814 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16815 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16816 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16817 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16818
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016819set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016820 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16821 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16822 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016823 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016824 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16825 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016826 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016827 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16828 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016829 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016830 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016831
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016832sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016833 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016834 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16835
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016836sha2([<bits>])
16837 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16838 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16839
16840 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16841 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16842
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016843 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016844 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16845
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016846srv_queue
16847 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16848 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16849 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16850 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16851 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16852
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016853strcmp(<var>)
16854 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16855 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16856 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16857 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16858 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16859 shorter).
16860
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016861 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16862 strings in constant time.
16863
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016864 Example :
16865
16866 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16867 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16868 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16869
16870
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016871sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016872 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16873 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016874 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016875 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16876 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016877 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016878 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16879 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016880 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016881 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16882 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016883 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016884 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016885
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016886table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16889 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16890 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16891 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16892 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16893
16894
16895table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16899 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16900 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16901 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16902
16903table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16904 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16905 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016906 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016907 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16908 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16909
16910table_conn_cur(<table>)
16911 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16912 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16913 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16914 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16915 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16916
16917table_conn_rate(<table>)
16918 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16919 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16920 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16921 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16922 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16923
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020016924table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
16925 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16926 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16927 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
16928 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
16929 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16930 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16931 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
16932 data-type).
16933 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
16934
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016935table_gpt0(<table>)
16936 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16937 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16938 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16939 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16940 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16941
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020016942table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
16943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16945 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
16946 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
16947 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
16948 between 0 and 99.
16949 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16950 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
16951 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
16952 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
16953
16954table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
16955 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16956 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16957 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
16958 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
16959 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
16960 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16961 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
16962 value 0.
16963 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
16964 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
16965 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
16966
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016967table_gpc0(<table>)
16968 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16969 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16970 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16971 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16972 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16973
16974table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16977 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16978 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16979 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16980 sample fetch keyword.
16981
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016982table_gpc1(<table>)
16983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16986 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16987 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16988
16989table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16992 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16993 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16994 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16995 sample fetch keyword.
16996
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016997table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16998 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16999 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017000 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017001 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17002 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17003
17004table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17007 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17008 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17009 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17010 keyword.
17011
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017012table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17016 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17017 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17018
17019table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17020 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17021 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17022 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17023 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17024 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17025 keyword.
17026
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017027table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17028 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17029 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017030 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017031 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17032 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17033
17034table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17035 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17036 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17037 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17038 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17039 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17040 keyword.
17041
17042table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17043 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17044 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017045 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017046 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17047 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17048 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17049 keyword.
17050
17051table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17052 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17053 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017054 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017055 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17056 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17057 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17058 keyword.
17059
17060table_server_id(<table>)
17061 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17062 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17063 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17064 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17065 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17066 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17067
17068table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17069 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17070 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017071 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017072 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17073 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17074 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17075 keyword.
17076
17077table_sess_rate(<table>)
17078 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17079 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17080 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17081 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17082 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17083 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17084 keyword.
17085
17086table_trackers(<table>)
17087 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17088 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17089 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17090 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17091 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17092 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17093 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17094 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17095 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17096 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17097
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017098ub64dec
17099 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17100 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17101 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17102
17103 Example:
17104 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17105 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17106
17107ub64enc
17108 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17109
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017110upper
17111 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17112 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17113 type. The result is of type string.
17114
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017115url_dec([<in_form>])
17116 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17117 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17118 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17119 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17120 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17121 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017122
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017123url_enc([<enc_type>])
17124 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17125 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17126 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17127 optional argument is here for future changes.
17128
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017129ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017130 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017131 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17132 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17133 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017134 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17135 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17136 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17137 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017138 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017139 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17140 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017141
17142 Example:
17143 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17144 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17145
17146 message Point {
17147 int32 latitude = 1;
17148 int32 longitude = 2;
17149 }
17150
17151 message PPoint {
17152 Point point = 59;
17153 }
17154
17155 message Rectangle {
17156 // One corner of the rectangle.
17157 PPoint lo = 48;
17158 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17159 PPoint hi = 49;
17160 }
17161
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017162 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17163 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17164 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017165
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017166 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17167 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017168 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017169 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17170
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017171 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017172
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017173 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017174
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017175 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17176 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17177 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017178
17179 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17180 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17181 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17182
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017183 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17184 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17185 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017186
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017187
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017188unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017189 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17190 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17191 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17192 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17193 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17194 response),
17195 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17196 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17197 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17198 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17199
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017200utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17201 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17202 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17203 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17204 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17205 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17206 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17207
17208 Example :
17209
17210 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017211 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017212 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17213
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017214word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17215 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17216 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17217 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017218 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017219 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17220 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17221
17222 Example :
17223 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17224 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17225 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17226 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17227 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017228 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017229
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017230wt6([<avalanche>])
17231 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17232 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17233 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17234 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17235 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17236 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17237 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017238 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17239 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017240
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017241xor(<value>)
17242 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017243 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017244 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017245 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017246 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017247 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17248 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017249 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017250 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17251 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017252 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017253 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017254
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017255xxh3([<seed>])
17256 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17257 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17258 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17259 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17260 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17261 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17262 considered as cryptographically secure.
17263
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017264xxh32([<seed>])
17265 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17266 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17267 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17268 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17269 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17270 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17271 as cryptographically secure.
17272
17273xxh64([<seed>])
17274 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17275 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17276 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17277 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17278 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17279 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17280 as cryptographically secure.
17281
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017282
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172837.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017284--------------------------------------------
17285
17286A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17287not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17288"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17289The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17290
17291always_false : boolean
17292 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17293 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17294
17295always_true : boolean
17296 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17297 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17298
17299avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017300 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017301 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17302 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17303 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17304 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17305 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17306 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17307 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17308 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17309 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17310 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17311 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17312 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17313 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017315be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017316 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17317 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17318 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17319 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017320 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17321
17322be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17323 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17324 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17325 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17326 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17327 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017328 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17329 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017330
17331 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17332 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17333 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017335be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17336 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17337 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17338 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017339 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017340 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17341 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017342
17343 Example :
17344 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17345 backend dynamic
17346 mode http
17347 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17348 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017349
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017350bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017351 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17352 of the string.
17353
17354bool(<bool>) : bool
17355 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17356 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017358connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17359 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017360 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017361 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17362 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017363
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017364 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017365 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017366 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17367
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017368 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17369 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017370
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017371 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017372 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017373 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017374 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017375 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017376 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017377 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017378
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017379 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17380 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017381 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017382 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017383
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017384cpu_calls : integer
17385 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17386 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17387 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17388 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17389 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17390 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17391
17392cpu_ns_avg : integer
17393 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17394 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17395 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17396 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17397 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17398 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17399 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17400 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17401 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17402 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17403 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17404
17405cpu_ns_tot : integer
17406 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17407 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17408 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17409 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17410 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17411 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17412 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17413 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17414 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17415 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17416 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17417 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17418 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17419
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017420date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017421 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017422
17423 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17424 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17425 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017426 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17427
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017428 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17429 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17430 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17431 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17432 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17433
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017434 Example :
17435
17436 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17437 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017438
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017439 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17440 # millisecond granularity
17441 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17442
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017443date_us : integer
17444 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17445 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17446 from the same timeval structure.
17447
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017448distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17449 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17450 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17451 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17452 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017453 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017454 list of supported tokens.
17455
17456distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17457 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17458 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17459 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17460 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017461 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017462 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17463 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17464 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17465 supported tokens.
17466
17467 Example :
17468 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17469 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17470 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17471 # send large files to the big farm
17472 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17473
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017474env(<name>) : string
17475 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17476 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17477 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17478 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17479 certain way.
17480
17481 Examples :
17482 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17483 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17484
17485 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17486 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017488fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17489 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017490 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17491 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017492 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17493 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017494 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017495 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17496 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017497
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017498fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17499 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17500 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17501 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017503fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17504 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17505 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17506 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17507 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17508 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17509 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17510 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17511 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017512
17513 Example :
17514 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17515 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17516 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17517 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17518 frontend mail
17519 bind :25
17520 mode tcp
17521 maxconn 100
17522 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17523 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17524 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17525 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017526
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017527hostname : string
17528 Returns the system hostname.
17529
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017530int(<integer>) : signed integer
17531 Returns a signed integer.
17532
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017533ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17534 Returns an ipv4.
17535
17536ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17537 Returns an ipv6.
17538
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017539lat_ns_avg : integer
17540 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17541 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17542 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17543 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17544 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17545 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17546 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17547 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17548 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017549 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17550 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17551 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17552 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17553 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17554 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017555
17556lat_ns_tot : integer
17557 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17558 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17559 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17560 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17561 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17562 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17563 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17564 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17565 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017566 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17567 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17568 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17569 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17570 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017571 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17572 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17573 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17574 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17575 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17576 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17577
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017578meth(<method>) : method
17579 Returns a method.
17580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017581nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17582 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17583 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17584 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017585 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17586 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17587 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017588
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017589prio_class : integer
17590 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17591 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17592 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17593
17594prio_offset : integer
17595 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17596 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17597 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17598 set-priority-offset".
17599
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017600proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017601 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17602 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017604queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017605 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17606 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17607 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017608 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17609 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17610 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17611 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17612 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17613
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017614rand([<range>]) : integer
17615 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17616 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17617 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17618 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17619 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017621srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17622 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17623 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17624 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17625 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17626 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017627 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17628 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17629
17630srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17631 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17632 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17633 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17634 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17635 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17636 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17637 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17638
17639 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17640 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017641
17642srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17643 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17644 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17645 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017646 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017647 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17648 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17649 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17650
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017651srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17652 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17653 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17654 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17655 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17656 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17657 fetch methods.
17658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017659srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17660 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17661 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017662 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017663 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17664 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017665 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017666 overloading servers).
17667
17668 Example :
17669 # Redirect to a separate back
17670 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17671 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17672 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17673
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017674srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017675 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17676 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17677 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17678
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017679srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017680 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17681 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17682 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17683
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017684srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017685 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17686 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17687 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17688
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017689stopping : boolean
17690 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17691 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17692 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17693
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017694str(<string>) : string
17695 Returns a string.
17696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017697table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17698 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17699 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17700
17701table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17702 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17703 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17704 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17705
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017706thread : integer
17707 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17708 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17709 and debugging purposes.
17710
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017711uuid([<version>]) : string
17712 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17713 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17714 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17715
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017716var(<var-name>) : undefined
17717 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017718 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17719 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017720 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017721 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17722 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017723 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017724 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17725 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017726 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017727 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017728
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177297.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730----------------------------------
17731
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017732The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017733closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17734methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17735sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17736TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017737the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17738counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017739"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17740used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17741can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17742Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17743table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17744tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17745currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017746
Remi Tricot-Le Breton942c1672021-09-01 15:52:15 +020017747bc_conn_err : integer
17748 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
17749 connection. See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
17750 and their corresponding error message.
17751
17752bc_conn_err_str : string
17753 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
17754 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
17755 "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
17756 corresponding error message.
17757
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017758bc_dst : ip
17759 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17760 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17761 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17762 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17763
17764bc_dst_port : integer
17765 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017766 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017767
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017768bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017769 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17770 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17771 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17772
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017773bc_src : ip
17774 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017775 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017776 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17777 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17778
17779bc_src_port : integer
17780 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017781 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017783be_id : integer
17784 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017785 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17786 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017787
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017788be_name : string
17789 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017790 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17791 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017792
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017793be_server_timeout : integer
17794 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17795 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17796 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17797
17798be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17799 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17800 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17801 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17802
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017803cur_server_timeout : integer
17804 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17805 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17806 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17807
17808cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17809 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17810 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17811 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017813dst : ip
17814 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17815 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17816 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17817 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017818 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17819 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17820 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17821 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17822 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17823 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017824
17825dst_conn : integer
17826 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17827 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17828 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17829 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17830 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17831 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17832 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17833 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017834
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017835dst_is_local : boolean
17836 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17837 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17838 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17839 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017840 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017841 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17842 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17843 it only once per connection.
17844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017845dst_port : integer
17846 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17847 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17848 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17849 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17850 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17851 an HTTP header.
17852
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017853fc_conn_err : integer
17854 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
17855 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
17856 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017857 described in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017858 error codes and their corresponding error message.
17859
17860fc_conn_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017861 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017862 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
17863 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
17864 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
17865
17866 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17867 | ID | message |
17868 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17869 | 0 | "Success" |
17870 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
17871 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
17872 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
17873 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
17874 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
17875 | 6 | "General socket error" |
17876 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
17877 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
17878 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
17879 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
17880 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17881 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17882 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17883 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
17884 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
17885 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
17886 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
17887 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17888 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17889 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
17890 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
17891 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
17892 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
17893 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
17894 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
17895 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
17896 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
17897 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
17898 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
17899 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
17900 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
17901 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
17902 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
17903 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
17904 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
17905 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
17906 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
17907 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
17908 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
17909 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
17910 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
17911 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
17912 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17913
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017914fc_http_major : integer
17915 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17916 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17917 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17918
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017919fc_pp_authority : string
17920 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17921 if any.
17922
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017923fc_pp_unique_id : string
17924 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17925 if any.
17926
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017927fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17928 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17929 header.
17930
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017931fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17932 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17933 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17934 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17935 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17936 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17937 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17938
17939fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17940 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17941 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17942 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17943 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17944 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17945 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17946
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017947fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017948 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17949 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17950 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17951 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17952
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017953fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017954 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17955 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17956 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17957 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17958
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017959fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017960 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17961 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17962 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17963 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17964
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017965fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017966 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17967 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17968 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17969 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17970
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017971fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017972 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17973 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17974 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17975 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17976
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017977fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017978 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17979 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17980 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17981 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17982
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017983fe_defbe : string
17984 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17985 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017987fe_id : integer
17988 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017989 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017990 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17991
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017992fe_name : string
17993 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17994 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17995 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17996
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017997fe_client_timeout : integer
17998 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17999 current frontend.
18000
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018001sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018002sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18003sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18004sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018005 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18006 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18007 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18008
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018009sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018010sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18011sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18012sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018013 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18014 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18015 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18016
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018017sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18018 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18019 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18020 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18021 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18022 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18023 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18024 will always return zero.
18025 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18026 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18027
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018028sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018029sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18030sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18031sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018032 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18033 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018034 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18035 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18036 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018037
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018038 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018039 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18040 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018041 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18042 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18043 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018044 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18045 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18046
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018047sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18048sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18049sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18050sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18051 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18052 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18053 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18054 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18055 when a first ACL was verified.
18056
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018057sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018058sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18059sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18060sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018061 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018062 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18063
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018064sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018065sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18066sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18067sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018068 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18069 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18070 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18071
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018072sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018073sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18074sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18075sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018076 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18077 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18078 See also src_conn_rate.
18079
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018080sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18081 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18082 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18083 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18084 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18085 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18086 index, zero is returned.
18087 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18088 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18089
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018090sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018091sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18092sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18093sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018094 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018095 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018096
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018097sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18098sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18099sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18100sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18101 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18102 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18103
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018104sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18105 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18106 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18107 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18108 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18109 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18110 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18111 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18112
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018113sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18114sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18115sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18116sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18117 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18118 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18119
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018120sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18121 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18122 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18123 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18124 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18125 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18126 between 0 and 2.
18127 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18128 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18129 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18130 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18131 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18132
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018133sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018134sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18135sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18136sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018137 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18138 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18139 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018140 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18141 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18142 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018143
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018144sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18145sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18146sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18147sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18148 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18149 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18150 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18151 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18152 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18153 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18154
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018155sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018156sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18157sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18158sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018159 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018160 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18161 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18162
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018163sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018164sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18165sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18166sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018167 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18168 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18169 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18170 src_http_err_rate.
18171
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018172sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18173sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18174sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18175sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18176 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18177 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18178 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18179
18180sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18181sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18182sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18183sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18184 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18185 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18186 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18187 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018189sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018190sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18191sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18192sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018193 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018194 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18195 src_http_req_cnt.
18196
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018197sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018198sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18199sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18200sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018201 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18202 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18203 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18204 src_http_req_rate.
18205
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018206sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18207 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18208 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18209 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18210 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18211 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18212 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18213 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18214 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18215 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18216
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018217sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018218sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18219sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18220sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018221 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018222 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18223 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18224 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18225 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018226
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018227 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018228 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18229 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018230 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18231
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018232sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18233sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18234sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18235sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18236 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18237 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18238 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18239 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18240 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18241
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018242sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018243sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18244sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18245sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018246 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18247 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18248 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018249
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018250sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018251sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18252sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18253sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018254 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18255 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18256 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018257
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018258sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018259sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18260sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18261sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018262 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018263 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18264 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18265 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018266 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018267 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18268
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018269sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018270sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18271sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18272sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018273 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18274 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18275 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18276 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18277 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018278 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018279
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018280sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018281sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18282sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18283sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018284 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18285 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18286 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18287
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018288sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018289sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18290sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18291sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018292 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18293 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018294 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018295 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18296 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018297 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18298 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18299 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018301so_id : integer
18302 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18303 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18304 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018305
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018306so_name : string
18307 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18308 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18309 strings instead of integers.
18310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018311src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018312 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018313 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18314 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18315 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018316 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18317 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18318 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018319 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18320 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18321 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18322 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18323 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18324 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18325 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018326
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018327 Example:
18328 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18329 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018331src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18332 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18333 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18334 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018335 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018337src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18338 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18339 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018340 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018341 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018342
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018343src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18344 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18345 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18346 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18347 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18348 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18349 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18350 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18351 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018353src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18354 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18355 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18356 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18357 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18358 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18359 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018360
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018361 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018362 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18363 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18364 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18365 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018366 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018367 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18368 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18369
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018370src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18371 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18372 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18373 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18374 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18375 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18376 was verified.
18377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018379 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018380 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018381 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018382 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018384src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018385 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018386 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18387 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018388 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018390src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18391 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18392 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18393 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018394 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018395
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018396src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18397 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18398 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18399 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18400 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18401 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18402 is returned.
18403 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18404 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18405 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018407src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018408 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018409 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018410 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018411 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018412
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018413src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18414 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18415 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18416 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18417 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18418
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018419src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18420 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18421 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18422 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18423 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18424 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18425 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18426
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018427src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18428 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18429 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18430 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18431 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18432
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018433src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18434 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18435 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18436 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18437 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18438 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18439 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18440 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18441 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18442 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18443 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018445src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018446 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018447 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018448 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18449 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018450 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18451 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18452 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018453
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018454src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18455 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18456 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18457 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18458 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18459 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18460 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18461 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018463src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018464 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018465 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018466 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018467 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018468 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018470src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18471 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18472 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18473 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18474 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018475 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018476
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018477src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18478 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18479 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018480 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018481 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18482 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18483
18484src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18485 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18486 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18487 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18488 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18489 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18490 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018492src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018493 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018494 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18495 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018496 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018498src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18499 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18500 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18501 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018502 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018503 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018504
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018505src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18506 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18507 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18508 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18509 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18510 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18511 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18512 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18513 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018515src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18516 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18517 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18518 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018519 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018520 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18521 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018522
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018523 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018524 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018525 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018526 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018527
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018528src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18529 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18530 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18531 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18532 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18533 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18534 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18535
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018536src_is_local : boolean
18537 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18538 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18539 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18540 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018541 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018542 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18543 once per connection.
18544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018545src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018546 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18547 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18548 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18549 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18550 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018552src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018553 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18554 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18555 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18556 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18557 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018559src_port : integer
18560 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18561 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18562 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18563 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018565src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018566 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018567 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18568 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18569 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018570 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018572src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18573 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18574 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18575 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18576 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018577 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018579src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18580 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18581 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18582 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18583 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18584 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18585 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18586 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18587 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018588
18589 Example :
18590 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18591 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18592 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18593 listen ssh
18594 bind :22
18595 mode tcp
18596 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018597 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018598 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018599 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018601srv_id : integer
18602 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18603 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018604 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018605
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018606srv_name : string
18607 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18608 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018609 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018610
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200186117.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018612----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018613
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018614The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018615closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18616when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18617usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018618future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018619
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001862051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18621 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18622 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18623 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18624 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18625 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18626
18627 Example :
18628 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18629 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18630 # the request.
18631 frontend http-in
18632 bind *:8081
18633 default_backend servers
18634 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18635 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18636
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018637ssl_bc : boolean
18638 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18639 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018640 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18641 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018642
18643ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18644 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018645 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18646 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018647
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018648ssl_bc_alpn : string
18649 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18650 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018651 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018652 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18653 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18654 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18655 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18656 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018657 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18658 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018659
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018660ssl_bc_cipher : string
18661 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018662 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18663 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018664
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018665ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18666 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18667 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18668 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018669 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018670
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018671ssl_bc_hsk_err : integer
18672 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18673 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
18674 backend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. In order to get a text
18675 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_hsk_err_str"
18676 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
18677 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
18678 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
18679
18680ssl_bc_hsk_err_str : string
18681 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18682 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
18683 handshake on the backend side. See also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
18684
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018685ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18686 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18687 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018688 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18689 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018690
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018691ssl_bc_npn : string
18692 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18693 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018694 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018695 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18696 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18697 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18698 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018699 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18700 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018701
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018702ssl_bc_protocol : string
18703 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018704 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18705 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018706
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018707ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018708 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018709 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018710 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18711 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018712
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018713ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18714 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18715 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18716 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018717 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018718
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018719ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18720 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18721 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018722 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18723 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018724
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018725ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18726 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18727 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18728 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018729 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018730
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018731ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18732 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018733 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18734 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018736ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18737 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18738 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18739 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18740 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18741 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018743ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18744 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18745 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18746 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18747 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018748
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018749ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018750 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18751 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18752 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018753 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018754 does not support resumed sessions.
18755
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018756ssl_c_der : binary
18757 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18758 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18759 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018761ssl_c_err : integer
18762 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18763 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18764 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18765 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18766 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018767
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018768ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018769 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18770 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18771 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18772 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18773 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18774 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18775 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18776 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018777 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18778 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18779 LDAP v3.
18780 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18781 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018783ssl_c_key_alg : string
18784 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18785 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18786 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018788ssl_c_notafter : string
18789 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18790 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18791 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018793ssl_c_notbefore : string
18794 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18795 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18796 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018797
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018798ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018799 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18800 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18801 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18802 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18803 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18804 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18805 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18806 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018807 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18808 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18809 LDAP v3.
18810 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18811 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018813ssl_c_serial : binary
18814 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18815 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18816 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018818ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18819 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18820 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18821 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018822 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18823 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18824
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018825 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018826 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018828ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18829 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18830 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18831 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018833ssl_c_used : boolean
18834 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18835 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837ssl_c_verify : integer
18838 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18839 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18840 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18841 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843ssl_c_version : integer
18844 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18845 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018846
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018847ssl_f_der : binary
18848 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18849 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18850 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18851
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018852ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018853 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18854 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18855 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18856 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018857 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018858 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18859 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18860 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018861 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18862 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18863 LDAP v3.
18864 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18865 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018867ssl_f_key_alg : string
18868 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18869 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18870 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872ssl_f_notafter : string
18873 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18874 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18875 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018877ssl_f_notbefore : string
18878 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18879 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18880 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018881
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018882ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018883 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18884 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18885 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18886 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18887 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18888 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18889 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18890 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018891 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18892 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18893 LDAP v3.
18894 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18895 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018897ssl_f_serial : binary
18898 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18899 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18900 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018901
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018902ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18903 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18904 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18905 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018907ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18908 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18909 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18910 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018912ssl_f_version : integer
18913 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18914 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18915
18916ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018917 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18918 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18919 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018921 Example :
18922 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18923 listen http-https
18924 bind :80
18925 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18926 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18927
18928ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18929 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18930 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18931
18932ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018933 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018934 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018935 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018936 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18937 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18938 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18939 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18940 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18941 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018943ssl_fc_cipher : string
18944 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18945 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018946
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018947ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
18948 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18949 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018950 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018951 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18952 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18953 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018954
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018955 Example:
18956 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18957 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18958 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18959 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18960 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18961 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18962 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18963 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18964 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
18965
18966ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018967 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018968 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018969 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
18970 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018971 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18972 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018973
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018974ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018975 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018976 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018977 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018978 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18979 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18980 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
18981 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
18982 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
18983 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018984
18985ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018986 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018987 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
18988 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018989
18990ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
18991 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
18992 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018993 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018994
18995 Example:
18996 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18997 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18998 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18999 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19000 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19001 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19002 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19003 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19004 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19005
19006ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19007 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19008 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019009 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019010 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19011 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19012 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19013
19014 Example:
19015 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19016 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19017 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19018 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19019 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19020 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19021 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19022 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19023 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19024
19025ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19026 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19027 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019028 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019029 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19030 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19031 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19032
19033 Example:
19034 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19035 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19036 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19037 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19038 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19039 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19040 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19041 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19042 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019043
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019044ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19045 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19046 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19047 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19048
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019049ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19050 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19051 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19052 transport layer.
19053 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19054 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19055 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19056 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19057
19058ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19059 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19060 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19061 transport layer.
19062 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19063 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19064 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19065 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19066
19067ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19068 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19069 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19070 transport layer.
19071 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19072 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19073 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19074 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19075
19076ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19077 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19078 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19079 transport layer.
19080 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19081 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19082 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19083 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19084
19085ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19086 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19087 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19088 transport layer.
19089 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19090 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19091 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19092 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019094ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019095 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19096 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019097 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19098 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19099 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19100 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019101
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019102ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19103 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19104 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19105 wait until the handshake happened.
19106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019107ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19108 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019109 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19110 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019111 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019112 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019113
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c6898e2021-07-29 09:45:51 +020019114ssl_fc_hsk_err : integer
19115 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19116 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
19117 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. Any error happening during
19118 the client's certificate verification process will not be raised through this
19119 fetch but via the existing "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and
19120 "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get a text description of this
19121 error code, you can either use the "ssl_fc_hsk_err_str" sample fetch or use
19122 the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code in hexadecimal
19123 representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL library's
19124 documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19125
19126ssl_fc_hsk_err_str : string
19127 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19128 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
19129 handshake on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19130 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19131 also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
19132
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019133ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019134 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019135 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19136 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019138ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019139 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019140 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019141 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19142 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19143 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19144 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19145 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19146 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019148ssl_fc_protocol : string
19149 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19150 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019151
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019152ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19153 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19154 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019155 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19156 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019157
19158 Example:
19159 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19160 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19161 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19162 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19163 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19164 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19165 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19166 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19167 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19168
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019169ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019170 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019171 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
19172 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019173
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019174ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19175 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19176 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19177 transport layer.
19178 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19179 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19180 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19181 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19182
19183ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19184 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19185 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19186 transport layer.
19187 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19188 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19189 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19190 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19191
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019192ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19193 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19194 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19195 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019197ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19198 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19199 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19200 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19201 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019202
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019203ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19204 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19205 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19206 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19207 BoringSSL.
19208
19209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019210ssl_fc_sni : string
19211 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19212 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019213 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019214 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19215 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19216
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019217 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019218 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019219 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019220 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019221 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019223 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019224 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19225 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019227ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19228 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19229 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019230
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019231ssl_s_der : binary
19232 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19233 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19234 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19235
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019236ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19237 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19238 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19239 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019240 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019241 does not support resumed sessions.
19242
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019243ssl_s_key_alg : string
19244 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19245 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19246 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19247
19248ssl_s_notafter : string
19249 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19250 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19251 transport layer.
19252
19253ssl_s_notbefore : string
19254 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19255 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19256 transport layer.
19257
19258ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19259 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19260 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19261 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19262 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19263 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19264 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019265 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19266 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019267 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19268 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19269 LDAP v3.
19270 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19271 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19272
19273ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19274 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19275 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19276 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19277 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19278 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19279 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019280 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19281 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019282 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19283 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19284 LDAP v3.
19285 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19286 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19287
19288ssl_s_serial : binary
19289 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19290 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19291 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19292
19293ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19294 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19295 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19296 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19297
19298ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19299 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19300 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19301 layer.
19302
19303ssl_s_version : integer
19304 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19305 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019306
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193077.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019308------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019310Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19311sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19312only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19313For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19314be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19315can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19316sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19317for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19318content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019319
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019320Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19321 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019322 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019323 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19324 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19325 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19326 sample expression). So be careful.
19327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019328payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019329 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019330 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19331 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019333payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19334 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019335 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019336 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019338req.len : integer
19339req_len : integer (deprecated)
19340 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19341 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19342 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19343 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19344 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019345 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019346 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19347 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019349req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19350 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019351 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19352 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19353 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19354 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019356 ACL alternatives :
19357 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019359req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19360 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19361 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19362 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19363 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019365 ACL alternatives :
19366 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019368 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019370req.proto_http : boolean
19371req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19372 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19373 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19374 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19375 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19376 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19377 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19378 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019380 Example:
19381 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19382 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19383 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019384 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019386req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19387rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19388 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19389 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19390 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19391 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19392 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19393 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19394 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019396 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19397 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19398 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19399 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19400 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19401 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019403 ACL derivatives :
19404 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019406 Example :
19407 listen tse-farm
19408 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19409 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19410 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19411 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19412 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19413 persist rdp-cookie
19414 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19415 # This is only useful makes sense if
19416 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19417 stick-table type string size 204800
19418 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19419 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19420 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019422 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19423 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019425req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19426rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19427 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19428 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19429 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19430 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019432 ACL derivatives :
19433 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019434
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019435req.ssl_alpn : string
19436 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19437 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19438 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19439 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19440 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19441 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019442 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019443
19444 Examples :
19445 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19446 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19447 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019448 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019449 default_backend bk_default
19450
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019451req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19452 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19453 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019454 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19455 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19456 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19457 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19458 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019460req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19461req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19462 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19463 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19464 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19465 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19466 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19467 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19468 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019470req.ssl_sni : string
19471req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19472 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19473 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19474 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19475 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19476 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019477 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19478 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19479 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19480 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19481 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19482 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19483 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19484 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19485 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019487 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019488 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019490 Examples :
19491 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19492 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19493 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019494 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019495 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019496
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019497req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19498 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19499 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19500 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19501 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19502 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19503 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19504 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19505 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19506 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019508req.ssl_ver : integer
19509req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19510 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19511 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19512 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19513 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19514 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19515 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19516 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019517 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019518 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019520 ACL derivatives :
19521 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019522
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019523res.len : integer
19524 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19525 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19526 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19527 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19528 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019529 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019530 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019531 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019533res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19534 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019535 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019536 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019537 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019538 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019540res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19541 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19542 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19543 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019544 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19545 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019547 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019548
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019549res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19550rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19551 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19552 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19553 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19554 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19555 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19556 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19557 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559wait_end : boolean
19560 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19561 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019562 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019563 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19564 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019565 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019566 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19567 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019569 Examples :
19570 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19571 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19572 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019574 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19575 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19576 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19577 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19578 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19579 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19580 tcp-request content reject
19581
19582
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200195837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019584--------------------------------------
19585
19586It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19587This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19588data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19589its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19590HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19591content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19592to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19593more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19594response are indexed.
19595
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019596Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19597 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19598 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19599 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19600 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19601 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19602 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019604base : string
19605 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19606 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19607 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19608 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19609 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19610 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19611 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19612 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19613
19614 ACL derivatives :
19615 base : exact string match
19616 base_beg : prefix match
19617 base_dir : subdir match
19618 base_dom : domain match
19619 base_end : suffix match
19620 base_len : length match
19621 base_reg : regex match
19622 base_sub : substring match
19623
19624base32 : integer
19625 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19626 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19627 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019628 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19629 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19630 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019631
19632base32+src : binary
19633 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19634 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19635 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19636 per-URL counters.
19637
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019638baseq : string
19639 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19640 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19641 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19642 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19643
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019644capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19645 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19646 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19647 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19648
19649capture.req.method : string
19650 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19651 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19652 because it's allocated.
19653
19654capture.req.uri : string
19655 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19656 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19657 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19658 allocated.
19659
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019660capture.req.ver : string
19661 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19662 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19663 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19664
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019665capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19666 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19667 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19668 The first entry is an index of 0.
19669 See also: "capture response header"
19670
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019671capture.res.ver : string
19672 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19673 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19674 persistent flag.
19675
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019676req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019677 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19678 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19679 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019680
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019681req.body_param([<name>) : string
19682 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19683 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19684 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19685 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19686 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19687 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19688 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19689 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19690 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19691 given.
19692
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019693req.body_len : integer
19694 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19695 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019696 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19697 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019698
19699req.body_size : integer
19700 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019701 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19702 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019704req.cook([<name>]) : string
19705cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19706 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19707 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19708 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19709 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19710 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19711 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19712 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19713 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19714
19715 ACL derivatives :
19716 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19717 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19718 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19719 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19720 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19721 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19722 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19723 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019725req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19726cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19727 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19728 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019730req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19731cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19732 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19733 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19734 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19735 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019737cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19738 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19739 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19740 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19741 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019742 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019743 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19744 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19745 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19746 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019748hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19749 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19750 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19751 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19752 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019753 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019755req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019756 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19757 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19758 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19759 with headers such as User-Agent.
19760
19761 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19762 found.
19763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019764 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19765 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19766 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019767 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019769req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19770 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19771 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019772 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19773 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019775req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019776 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19777 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19778 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19779 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19780 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19781 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19782 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19783
19784 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19785 found.
19786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019787 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19788 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19789 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019790 with -1 being the last one.
19791
19792 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19793 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019795 ACL derivatives :
19796 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19797 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19798 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19799 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19800 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19801 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19802 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19803 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19804
19805req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19806hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19807 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19808 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019809 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19810 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19811 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19812
19813 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19814 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19815 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19816
19817 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019818
19819req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19820hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19821 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19822 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19823 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019824 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19825 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19826 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19827 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19828 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019829
19830 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19831
19832 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019833
19834req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19835hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19836 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19837 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19838 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019839
19840 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19841
19842 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019843
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019844req.hdrs : string
19845 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19846 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19847 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19848 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19849
19850req.hdrs_bin : binary
19851 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19852 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19853 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19854 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19855 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19856 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19857
19858 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019859
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019860 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19861 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019863http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19864 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19865 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19866 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19867 basic auth is supported.
19868
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019869http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19870 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19871 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19872 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19873 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019874 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19875 basic auth is supported.
19876
19877 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019878 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19879 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19880 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19881 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019882
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019883http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019884 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19885 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19886 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019887
19888http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019889 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19890 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19891 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019892
19893http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019894 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19895 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19896 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019898http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019899 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19900 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019901 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19902 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019904method : integer + string
19905 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19906 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19907 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19908 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19909 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19910 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19911 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019913 ACL derivatives :
19914 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019916 Example :
19917 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19918 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19919 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019921path : string
19922 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19923 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19924 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19925 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19926 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019927 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019928 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019930 ACL derivatives :
19931 path : exact string match
19932 path_beg : prefix match
19933 path_dir : subdir match
19934 path_dom : domain match
19935 path_end : suffix match
19936 path_len : length match
19937 path_reg : regex match
19938 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019939
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019940pathq : string
19941 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19942 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19943 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19944 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19945 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19946 result in both cases.
19947
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019948query : string
19949 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19950 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19951 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19952 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019953 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019954 which stops before the question mark.
19955
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019956req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19957 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19958 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19959 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19960 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019962req.ver : string
19963req_ver : string (deprecated)
19964 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19965 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19966 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019968 ACL derivatives :
19969 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019970
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019971res.body : binary
19972 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19973 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019974 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19975
19976 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019977
19978res.body_len : integer
19979 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19980 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019981 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19982
19983 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019984
19985res.body_size : integer
19986 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19987 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19988 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19989 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019990 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19991
19992 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019993
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019994res.cache_hit : boolean
19995 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19996 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19997
19998res.cache_name : string
19999 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20000 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20001 empty string.
20002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020003res.comp : boolean
20004 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20005 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20006 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020008res.comp_algo : string
20009 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20010 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20011 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020013res.cook([<name>]) : string
20014scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20015 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20016 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020017 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20018
20019 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020021 ACL derivatives :
20022 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020024res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20025scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20026 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20027 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020028 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20029
20030 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020032res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20033scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20034 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20035 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020036 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20037
20038 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020040res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020041 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20042 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20043
20044 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20045 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20046
20047 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20048
20049 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020051res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020052 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20053 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20054
20055 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20056 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20057
20058 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020060res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20061shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020062 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20063 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20064
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020065 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020066 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20067
20068 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020070 ACL derivatives :
20071 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20072 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20073 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20074 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20075 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20076 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20077 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20078 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20079
20080res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20081shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020082 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20083 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20084
20085 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020086 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020087
20088 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020090res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20091shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020092 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20093 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20094
20095 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20096
20097 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020098
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020099res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20100 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20101 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20102 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020103 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20104
20105 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020107res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20108shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020109 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20110 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20111
20112 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20113
20114 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020115
20116res.hdrs : string
20117 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20118 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20119 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020120 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20121
20122 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020123
20124res.hdrs_bin : binary
20125 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20126 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20127 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20128 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20129 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20130 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20131 (length of 0 for both).
20132
20133 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20134
20135 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20136 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020138res.ver : string
20139resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20140 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020141 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20142
20143 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020145 ACL derivatives :
20146 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020148set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20149 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20150 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020151 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020152 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020154 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20155 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020157status : integer
20158 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20159 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020160 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20161
20162 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020163
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020164unique-id : string
20165 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20166 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20167 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20168 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20169 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20170 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020172url : string
20173 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20174 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20175 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20176 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20177 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20178 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20179 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020181 ACL derivatives :
20182 url : exact string match
20183 url_beg : prefix match
20184 url_dir : subdir match
20185 url_dom : domain match
20186 url_end : suffix match
20187 url_len : length match
20188 url_reg : regex match
20189 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020191url_ip : ip
20192 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20193 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20194 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20195 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020196 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20197 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020199url_port : integer
20200 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020201 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020202
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020203urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20204url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020205 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20206 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020207 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20208 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20209 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20210 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020211 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20212 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020213 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20214 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020216 ACL derivatives :
20217 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20218 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20219 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20220 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20221 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20222 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20223 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20224 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020225
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020227 Example :
20228 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20229 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20230 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20231 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020232
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020233urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020234 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20235 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20236 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020237
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020238url32 : integer
20239 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20240 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20241 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20242 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20243 is an unsigned integer.
20244
20245url32+src : binary
20246 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20247 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20248 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20249
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020250
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200202517.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020252---------------------------------------
20253
20254This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20255used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20256purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20257There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20258or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20259any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20260for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20261
20262internal.htx.data : integer
20263 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20264 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20265
20266internal.htx.free : integer
20267 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20268 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20269
20270internal.htx.free_data : integer
20271 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20272 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20273
20274internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020275 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20276 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20277 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020278
20279internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20280 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20281 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20282
20283internal.htx.size : integer
20284 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20285 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20286
20287internal.htx.used : integer
20288 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20289 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20290 direction.
20291
20292internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20293 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20294 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20295 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20296 of the special value :
20297 * head : The oldest inserted block
20298 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020299 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020300
20301internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20302 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20303 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20304 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20305 integer or one of the special value :
20306 * head : The oldest inserted block
20307 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020308 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020309
20310internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20311 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20312 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20313 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20314 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20315
20316 * head : The oldest inserted block
20317 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020318 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020319
20320internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20321 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20322 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20323 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20324 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20325
20326 * head : The oldest inserted block
20327 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020328 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020329
20330internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20331 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20332 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20333 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20334 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20335
20336 * head : The oldest inserted block
20337 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020338 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020339
20340internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20341 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20342 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20343 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20344 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20345
20346 * head : The oldest inserted block
20347 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020348 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020349
20350internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20351 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20352 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20353 it returns false.
20354
20355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200203567.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020357---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020359Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20360every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020361order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020363ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020364---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20365FALSE always_false never match
20366HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20367HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20368HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020369HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020370HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20371HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20372HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20373HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20374LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20375METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20376METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20377METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20378METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20379METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20380METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20381METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20382METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20383RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20384REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20385TRUE always_true always match
20386WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20387---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020388
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203908. Logging
20391----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020392
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020393One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20394provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20395very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20396provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20397state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020398to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020399headers.
20400
20401In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20402about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20403send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20404
20405 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20406 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20407 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20408 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20409 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020410 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020411 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020412
20413The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20414allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20415as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20416while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20417real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20418delay.
20419
20420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204218.1. Log levels
20422---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020423
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020424TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020425source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020426HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20427in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20428track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20429syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20430about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020431
20432
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204338.2. Log formats
20434----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020435
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020436HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020437and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20438slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20439options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020440
20441 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20442 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20443 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20444 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20445 extents.
20446
20447 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20448 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20449 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20450 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20451 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20452
20453 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20454 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20455 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20456 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20457 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20458
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020459 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20460 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20461 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20462 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20463
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020464 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20465
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020466Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20467specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20468field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20469servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20470always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20471identifier.
20472
20473Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20474 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20475 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20476 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20477 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20478
20479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204808.2.1. Default log format
20481-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020482
20483This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20484as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20485format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20486
20487 Example :
20488 listen www
20489 mode http
20490 log global
20491 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20492
20493 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20494 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20495 (www/HTTP)
20496
20497 Field Format Extract from the example above
20498 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20499 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20500 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20501 4 'to' to
20502 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20503 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20504
20505Detailed fields description :
20506 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20507 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20508 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20509 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20510 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20511 and processed the connection.
20512 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20513
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020514In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20515"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20516connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20517
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020518It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20519will eventually disappear.
20520
20521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205228.2.2. TCP log format
20523---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020524
20525The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20526is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20527information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20528counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20529emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20530environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20531the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20532sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020533specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20534not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20535fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20536marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020537
20538 Example :
20539 frontend fnt
20540 mode tcp
20541 option tcplog
20542 log global
20543 default_backend bck
20544
20545 backend bck
20546 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20547
20548 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20549 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20550 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20551
20552 Field Format Extract from the example above
20553 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20554 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20555 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20556 4 frontend_name fnt
20557 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20558 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20559 7 bytes_read* 212
20560 8 termination_state --
20561 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20562 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20563
20564Detailed fields description :
20565 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020566 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020567 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20568 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020569 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020570 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020571 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020572
20573 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020574 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20575 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20576 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020577
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020578 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020579 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20580 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020581 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20582 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20583 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20584 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020585
20586 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20587 and processed the connection.
20588
20589 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20590 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20591 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20592 applications.
20593
20594 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20595 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20596 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20597 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20598 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20599
20600 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20601 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20602 See "Timers" below for more details.
20603
20604 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20605 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20606 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20607 "Timers" below for more details.
20608
20609 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020610 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020611 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20612 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20613 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20614 details.
20615
20616 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20617 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20618 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20619 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20620 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20621
20622 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20623 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20624 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20625 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20626 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20627 for more details.
20628
20629 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020630 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020631 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20632 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20633 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020634 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020635
20636 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20637 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20638 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20639 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20640 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20641 caused by a denial of service attack.
20642
20643 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20644 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20645 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20646 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20647 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20648 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20649 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20650 denial of service attack.
20651
20652 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20653 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20654 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20655 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20656 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20657 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20658 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20659 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20660 be processed than on other servers.
20661
20662 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20663 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20664 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20665 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020666 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020667 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20668 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20669 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20670 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20671 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20672 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20673 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20674 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20675
20676 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20677 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20678 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20679 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20680 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20681 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020682 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020683 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20684
20685 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20686 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20687 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20688 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20689 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20690 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020691 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020692 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20693 occurs.
20694
20695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206968.2.3. HTTP log format
20697----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020698
20699The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20700is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20701the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20702are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20703emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20704generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20705"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20706which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020707frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20708is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020709
20710Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20711slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20712with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20713
20714 Example :
20715 frontend http-in
20716 mode http
20717 option httplog
20718 log global
20719 default_backend bck
20720
20721 backend static
20722 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20723
20724 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20725 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20726 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020727 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020728
20729 Field Format Extract from the example above
20730 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20731 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020732 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020733 4 frontend_name http-in
20734 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020735 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020736 7 status_code 200
20737 8 bytes_read* 2750
20738 9 captured_request_cookie -
20739 10 captured_response_cookie -
20740 11 termination_state ----
20741 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20742 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20743 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20744 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20745 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020746
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020747Detailed fields description :
20748 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020749 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020750 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20751 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020752 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020753 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020754 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020755
20756 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020757 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20758 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20759 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020760
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020761 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020762 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020763
20764 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20765 and processed the connection.
20766
20767 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20768 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20769 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20770
20771 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20772 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20773 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20774 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20775 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20776 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20777
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020778 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20779 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20780 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020781 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020782 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20783 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020784 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020785 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020786
20787 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20788 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020789 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020790
20791 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20792 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020793 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20794 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020795
20796 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20797 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20798 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20799 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20800 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020801 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20802 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020803
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020804 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020805 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20806 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20807 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20808 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20809 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20810 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020811 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020812
20813 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020814 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20815 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020816
20817 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20818 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020819 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020820 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20821 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20822 overflowing.
20823
20824 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20825 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20826 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20827 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20828 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20829 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20830 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20831 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20832
20833 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20834 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20835 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20836 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20837 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20838 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20839 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20840 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20841
20842 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20843 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20844 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20845 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20846 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20847 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20848 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20849
20850 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020851 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020852 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20853 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20854 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020855 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020856 system.
20857
20858 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20859 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20860 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20861 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20862 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20863 caused by a denial of service attack.
20864
20865 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20866 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20867 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20868 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20869 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20870 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20871 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20872 denial of service attack.
20873
20874 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20875 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20876 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20877 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20878 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20879 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20880 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20881 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20882 processed than on other servers.
20883
20884 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20885 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20886 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20887 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020888 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020889 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20890 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20891 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20892 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20893 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20894 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20895 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20896 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20897
20898 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20899 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20900 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20901 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20902 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20903 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020904 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020905 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20906
20907 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20908 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20909 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20910 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20911 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20912 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020913 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020914 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20915 occurs.
20916
20917 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20918 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20919 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20920 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20921 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20922 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20923 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20924 cookies" below for more details.
20925
20926 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20927 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20928 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20929 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20930 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20931 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20932 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20933 and cookies" below for more details.
20934
20935 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20936 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20937 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20938 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20939 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20940 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20941 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20942 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20943
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020944
209458.2.4. HTTPS log format
20946----------------------
20947
20948The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
20949extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
20950information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
20951frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
20952end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
20953matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
20954sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
20955dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
20956"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
20957
20958This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
20959appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
20960HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020961
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020962 Example :
20963 frontend https-in
20964 mode http
20965 option httpslog
20966 log global
20967 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
20968 default_backend bck
20969
20970 backend static
20971 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
20972
20973 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20974 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
20975 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
20976 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0 TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
20977
20978 Field Format Extract from the example above
20979 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20980 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
20981 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
20982 4 frontend_name https-in
20983 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
20984 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
20985 7 status_code 200
20986 8 bytes_read* 2750
20987 9 captured_request_cookie -
20988 10 captured_response_cookie -
20989 11 termination_state ----
20990 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20991 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20992 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20993 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20994 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020020995 17 fc_conn_err '/' ssl_fc_hsk_err '/' ssl_c_err '/' ssl_c_ca_err 0/0/0/0
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020996 18 ssl_version '/' ssl_ciphers TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
20997
20998Detailed fields description :
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020020999 - "fc_conn_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021000 corresponds to the "fc_conn_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_conn_err" and
21001 "fc_conn_err_str" fetches for more information.
21002
21003 - "ssl_fc_hsk_err" is the status of the SSL handshake from the frontend's
21004 point of view. It will be 0 if everything went well. See the
21005 "ssl_fc_hsk_err" sample fetch's description for more information.
21006
21007 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21008 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21009 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21010 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21011
21012 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21013 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21014 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21015 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21016
21017 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21018
21019 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21020
21021
210228.2.5. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021023------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021024
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021025The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021026mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021027
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021028HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021029Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21030separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21031prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21032
21033Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21034variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021035("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021036
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021037If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021038as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021039less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21040the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21041
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021042Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21043"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21044delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21045preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021046
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021047Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21048'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21049https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21050such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21051
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021052Flags are :
21053 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021054 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021055 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21056 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021057
21058 Example:
21059
21060 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21061 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21062
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021063 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21064
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021065At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
21066
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021067 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21068 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021069
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021070the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021071
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021072 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21073 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21074 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021075
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021076the default HTTPS format is defined this way :
21077
21078 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21079 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21080 %[fc_conn_err]/%[ssl_fc_hsk_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err] \
21081 %sslv/%sslc"
21082
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021083and the default TCP format is defined this way :
21084
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021085 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21086 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021087
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021088Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21089
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021090 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021091 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021092 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21093 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21094 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021095 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21096 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21097 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021098 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021099 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021100 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021101 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021102 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021103 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21104 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021105 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021106 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021107 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021108 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021109 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021110 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021111 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021112 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21113 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21114 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21115 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21116 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021117 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021118 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021119 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021120 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021121 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021122 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21123 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021124 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21125 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21126 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021127 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021128 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21129 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021130 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021131 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21132 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21133 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021134 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021135 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021136 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21137 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21138 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21139 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021140 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021141 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021142 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021143 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021144 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021145 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021146 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21147 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21148 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021149 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021150 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21151 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021152 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021153 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21154 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021155 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021156 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021157 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021158 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021159
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021160 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021161
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021162
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +0200211638.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021164-----------------------
21165
21166When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +020021167protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21168unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21169line. In the latter case, the legacy log format described below will not be
21170used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the defined format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021171By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21172"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021173will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +020021174logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021175
21176The format looks like this :
21177
21178 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21179 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21180 Connection error during SSL handshake
21181
21182 Field Format Extract from the example above
21183 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21184 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21185 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21186 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21187 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21188
21189These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21190failures.
21191
21192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211938.3. Advanced logging options
21194-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021195
21196Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21197just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21198options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21199for more information about their usage.
21200
21201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21203------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021204
21205It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021206HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021207commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21208monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21209ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21210
21211 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21212 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21213 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21214 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21215
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021216 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21217 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021218
21219 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21220 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21221 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21222
21223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212248.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21225----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021226
21227The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21228what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21229or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021230"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021231just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21232log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21233after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21234is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21235with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21236with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21237
21238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212398.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21240------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021241
21242Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21243for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21244"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21245retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21246raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21247a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21248file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21249you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21250"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21251
21252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212538.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21254--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021255
21256Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21257multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21258them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21259"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21260logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21261error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21262and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21263too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21264useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21265alternative.
21266
21267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212688.4. Timing events
21269------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021270
21271Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21272reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21273the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21274frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021275mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21276addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21277
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021278Timings events in HTTP mode:
21279
21280 first request 2nd request
21281 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21282 t tr t tr ...
21283 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21284 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21285 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21286 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021287 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021288 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21289
21290Timings events in TCP mode:
21291
21292 TCP session
21293 |<----------------->|
21294 t t
21295 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21296 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21297 |<------ Tt ------->|
21298
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021299 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021300 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021301 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21302 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21303 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021304 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021305 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21306 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21307 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21308 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021309
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021310 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21311 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21312 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021313 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21314 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21315 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21316 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21317 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21318 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021319
21320 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21321 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21322 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21323 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21324 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21325 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21326 request typed by hand during a test.
21327
21328 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21329 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021330 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021331 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21332 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21333 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21334 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021335
21336 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21337 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21338 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21339 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21340 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21341
21342 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21343 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21344 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21345 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21346 connection never established.
21347
21348 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21349 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21350 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21351 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21352 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21353 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21354 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21355 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21356 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21357 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21358 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21359
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021360 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21361 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21362 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21363 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21364 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21365 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21366
21367 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21368
21369 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21370 "Ta" can never be negative.
21371
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021372 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21373 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021374 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21375 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021376 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021377
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021378 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021379
21380 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021381 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21382 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021383
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021384 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21385 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21386 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21387 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21388 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21389 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21390 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21391 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21392
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021393These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21394protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21395that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021396due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21397"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21398that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021399
21400Most common cases :
21401
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021402 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21403 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21404 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21405 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21406 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021407 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021408 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21409 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21410 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21411 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21412 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021413 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021414
21415 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21416 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21417 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21418 of ms on remote networks.
21419
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021420 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21421 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21422 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021423
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021424 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21425 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021426 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021427 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21428 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21429 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21430 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21431 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21432 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021433
21434Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21435
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021436 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021437 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021438 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021439
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021440 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021441 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21442 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21443
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021444 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021445 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21446 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21447 flags.
21448
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021449 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21450 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021451 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21452 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21453 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21454 the client connection was maintained open.
21455
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021456 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021457 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021458 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021459 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21460
21461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214628.5. Session state at disconnection
21463-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021464
21465TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21466"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
214672-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21468each of which has a special meaning :
21469
21470 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21471 session to terminate :
21472
21473 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21474
21475 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21476 server explicitly refused it.
21477
21478 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21479 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21480 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21481 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021482 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021483
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021484 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021485 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021486
21487 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21488 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21489 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21490 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21491 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21492
21493 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21494 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21495 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21496 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21497 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21498
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021499 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021500 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21501
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021502 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021503 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21504 backup connections when going up.
21505
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021506 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021507
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021508 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21509 send or receive data.
21510
21511 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21512 send or receive data.
21513
21514 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21515 with nothing left in the buffers.
21516
21517 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21518
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021519 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021520 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21521
21522 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21523 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21524 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21525 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21526 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21527
21528 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21529 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21530
21531 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21532 server (HTTP only).
21533
21534 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21535
21536 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21537 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21538 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21539
21540 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21541 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21542 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21543
21544 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21545
21546 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21547 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21548
21549 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21550 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21551 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21552
21553 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21554 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021555 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21556 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021557
21558 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21559 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21560 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21561 another server.
21562
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021563 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021564 server.
21565
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021566 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21567 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21568 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21569 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21570
21571 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21572 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21573 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21574 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21575
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021576 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21577 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21578 "use-server" rule).
21579
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021580 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21581
21582 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21583 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21584
21585 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21586
21587 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21588 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21589 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21590
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021591 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21592 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021593 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021594 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21595 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21596
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021597 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21598
21599 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21600 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21601
21602 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21603
21604 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21605
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021606The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21607was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021608helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21609starvation, attacks, etc...
21610
21611The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21612alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21613easier finding and understanding.
21614
21615 Flags Reason
21616
21617 -- Normal termination.
21618
21619 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021620 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21621 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021622 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21623
21624 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21625 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021626 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21627 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021628 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21629 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021630
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021631 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21632 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021633 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021634
21635 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21636 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21637 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21638
21639 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21640 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21641 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21642 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21643 the server takes too long to respond.
21644
21645 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21646 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21647 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21648 long a time to respond.
21649
21650 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21651 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21652 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021653 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021654 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21655 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021656
21657 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21658 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21659 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21660 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21661 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021662 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021663 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21664 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21665 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21666 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21667 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21668 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21669 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21670 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021671 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021672 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21673 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21674 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021675
21676 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21677 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021678 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21679 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21680 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21681 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021682
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021683 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021684 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21685
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021686 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021687 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21688 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021689 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021690 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21691 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21692
21693 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21694 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21695 503 or 504 here.
21696
21697 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021698 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021699 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21700 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21701 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21702
21703 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21704 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021705 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021706 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021707 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021708
21709 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21710 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21711 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21712 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21713 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21714 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021715 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021716
21717 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21718 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21719 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21720 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21721 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21722 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21723 solution is to fix the application.
21724
21725 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21726 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21727 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21728 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21729 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21730 external attacks.
21731
21732 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021733 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021734 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021735 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21736 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21737
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021738 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21739 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21740 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021741 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021742 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021743
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021744 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21745 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21746 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21747 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021748 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21749 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21750 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21751 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21752 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021753
21754 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21755 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21756 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21757 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21758
21759 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21760 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21761 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21762 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21763
21764 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21765 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21766 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21767 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21768
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021769The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021770persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021771important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21772re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21773
21774 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21775
21776 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21777 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21778 set on a GET request.
21779
21780 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21781 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021782 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021783 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21784
21785 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21786 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21787 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21788
21789 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21790 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21791 already got a cookie.
21792
21793 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21794 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21795 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21796 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21797 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21798
21799 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21800 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21801 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21802
21803 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21804 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21805 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21806
21807 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21808 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21809
21810 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21811 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21812 then advertised in the response.
21813
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218158.6. Non-printable characters
21816-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021817
21818In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21819consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21820converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21821prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21822being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21823escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21824is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21825'}' when logging headers.
21826
21827Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21828issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21829containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21830
21831Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21832the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21833performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21834
21835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218368.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21837---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021838
21839Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21840achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021841section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021842cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21843the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21844the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021845locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021846not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21847user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21848a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21849wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21850
21851 Examples :
21852 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21853 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21854
21855 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21856 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21857
21858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218598.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21860---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021861
21862Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21863proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21864the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21865server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21866
21867Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21868response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021869section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021870
21871It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021872time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21873appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021874are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21875and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21876follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21877request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21878in the logs.
21879
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021880As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21881frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21882an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21883
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021884 Example :
21885 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21886 listen proxy-out
21887 mode http
21888 option httplog
21889 option logasap
21890 log global
21891 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21892
21893 # log the name of the virtual server
21894 capture request header Host len 20
21895
21896 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21897 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21898
21899 # log the beginning of the referrer
21900 capture request header Referer len 20
21901
21902 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21903 capture response header Server len 20
21904
21905 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21906 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21907
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021908 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021909 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21910
21911 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21912 capture response header Via len 20
21913
21914 # log the URL location during a redirection
21915 capture response header Location len 20
21916
21917 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21918 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21919 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21920 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21921 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21922
21923 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21924 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21925 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21926 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021927 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021928
21929 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21930 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21931 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21932 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21933 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021934 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021935
21936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219378.9. Examples of logs
21938---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021939
21940These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21941them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21942reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21943
21944 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21945 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21946 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21947
21948 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21949 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21950
21951 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21952 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21953 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21954
21955 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21956 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21957
21958 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21959 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21960 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21961
21962 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021963 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021964 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21965 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21966
21967 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21968 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21969 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21970
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021971 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21972 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21973 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21974 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021975 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021976 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021977
21978 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021979 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021980
21981 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21982 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21983 Nothing was sent to any server.
21984
21985 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21986 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21987
21988 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21989 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021990 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021991 send a 408 return code to the client.
21992
21993 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21994 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21995
21996 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21997 5 seconds ("c----").
21998
21999 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22000 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022001 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022002
22003 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022004 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022005 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22006 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22007 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22008 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22009 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022010
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022011
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200220129. Supported filters
22013--------------------
22014
22015Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22016accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22017unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22018
22019See also : "filter"
22020
220219.1. Trace
22022----------
22023
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022024filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022025
22026 Arguments:
22027 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22028 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22029
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022030 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022031
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022032 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022033 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22034 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22035 amount of the parsed data.
22036
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022037 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022038
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022039This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22040callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22041information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22042filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22043
22044Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22045tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22046a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22047
22048
220499.2. HTTP compression
22050---------------------
22051
22052filter compression
22053
22054The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22055keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022056when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22057fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22058done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22059explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22060filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22061listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22062order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022063
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022064See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22065 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022066
22067
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200220689.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22069--------------------------------------------
22070
22071filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22072
22073 Arguments :
22074
22075 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22076 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22077 parsed.
22078
22079 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22080 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22081 part must be placed in its own scope.
22082
22083The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22084external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022085streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022086exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22087also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22088
22089SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22090the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22091
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022092For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022093"doc/SPOE.txt".
22094
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100220959.4. Cache
22096----------
22097
22098filter cache <name>
22099
22100 Arguments :
22101
22102 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22103
22104The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22105"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022106cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022107other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22108case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22109is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22110filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022111listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22112order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022113
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022114See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22115 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22116
22117
221189.5. Fcgi-app
22119-------------
22120
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022121filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022122
22123 Arguments :
22124
22125 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22126
22127The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22128request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22129reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22130used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22131implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22132used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22133fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22134used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22135order.
22136
22137See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22138 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22139
22140
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100221419.6. OpenTracing
22142----------------
22143
22144The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22145HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22146of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22147Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22148
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022149This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022150
22151The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22152HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22153participates in the work of HAProxy.
22154
22155filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22156
22157 Arguments :
22158
22159 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22160 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22161 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22162 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22163 OpenTracing filters.
22164
22165 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22166 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22167 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22168 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22169 filter must have its own scope defined.
22170
22171More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022172of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022173
22174
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002217510. FastCGI applications
22176-------------------------
22177
22178HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22179feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22180the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22181FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22182servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22183FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22184backend.
22185
22186HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22187application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22188connection.
22189
2219010.1. Setup
22191-----------
22192
2219310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22194--------------------------
22195
22196fcgi-app <name>
22197 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22198 document root must be defined.
22199
22200acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22201 Declare or complete an access list.
22202
22203 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22204 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22205 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22206 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22207 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22208
22209docroot <path>
22210 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22211 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22212 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22213
22214index <script-name>
22215 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22216 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22217 is an optional setting.
22218
22219 Example :
22220 index index.php
22221
22222log-stderr global
22223log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022224 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022225 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22226
22227 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22228 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22229
22230pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22231 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22232 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22233 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22234
22235 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22236 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22237 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22238 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22239
22240 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22241 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22242
22243path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022244 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022245 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22246 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22247 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22248 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22249 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22250 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22251 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022252
22253 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022254 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022255 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22256 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22257 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22258 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022259
22260 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022261 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22262 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022263
22264option get-values
22265no option get-values
22266 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22267
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022268 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022269 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22270
22271 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22272 application will accept.
22273
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022274 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22275 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022276
22277 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022278 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022279 option is disabled.
22280
22281 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22282 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22283 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22284 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22285 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22286 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22287
22288option keep-conn
22289no option keep-conn
22290 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22291 sending a response.
22292
22293 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22294 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22295
22296option max-reqs <reqs>
22297 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22298 accept.
22299
22300 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22301 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22302 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22303 to 1.
22304
22305option mpxs-conns
22306no option mpxs-conns
22307 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22308
22309 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22310 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22311
22312set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22313 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22314 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22315 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22316 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22317
22318 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22319 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22320 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22321
22322 Example :
22323 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22324 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22325
22326 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22327
22328
2232910.1.2. Proxy section
22330---------------------
22331
22332use-fcgi-app <name>
22333 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22334
22335 Arguments :
22336 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22337
22338 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22339 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22340 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22341 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22342 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22343
22344 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22345 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22346 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22347 application are evaluated.
22348
22349
2235010.1.3. Example
22351---------------
22352
22353 frontend front-http
22354 mode http
22355 bind *:80
22356 bind *:
22357
22358 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22359 default_backend back-static
22360
22361 backend back-static
22362 mode http
22363 server www A.B.C.D:80
22364
22365 backend back-dynamic
22366 mode http
22367 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22368 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22369
22370 fcgi-app php-fpm
22371 log-stderr global
22372 option keep-conn
22373
22374 docroot /var/www/my-app
22375 index index.php
22376 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22377
22378
2237910.2. Default parameters
22380------------------------
22381
22382A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22383the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022384script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022385applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22386
22387 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22388 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22389 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22390 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22391 | | |
22392 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22393 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22394 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22395 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22396 | | application. |
22397 | | |
22398 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22399 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22400 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22401 | | |
22402 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22403 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22404 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22405 | | the application's configuration. |
22406 | | |
22407 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22408 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22409 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22410 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22411 | | |
22412 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22413 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22414 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22415 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22416 | | be defined. |
22417 | | |
22418 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22419 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22420 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22421 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22422 | | is not set too. |
22423 | | |
22424 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22425 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22426 | | set. |
22427 | | |
22428 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22429 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22430 | | the request. |
22431 | | |
22432 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22433 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22434 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22435 | | |
22436 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22437 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22438 | | script to process the request. |
22439 | | |
22440 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22441 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22442 | | |
22443 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22444 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22445 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22446 | | |
22447 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22448 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22449 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22450 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22451 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22452 | | |
22453 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22454 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22455 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22456 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22457 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22458 | | side. |
22459 | | |
22460 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22461 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22462 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22463 | | connected to. |
22464 | | |
22465 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22466 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22467 | | |
22468 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022469 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22470 | | current HAProxy version. |
22471 | | |
22472 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022473 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22474 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22475 | | |
22476 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22477
22478
2247910.3. Limitations
22480------------------
22481
22482The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22483way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22484during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22485establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22486application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22487or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22488message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22489these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22490and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22491
22492Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22493request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22494requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22495
22496About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22497into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22498fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22499"http-request" ones.
22500
22501Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22502FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22503processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22504must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22505here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022506
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022507
2250811. Address formats
22509-------------------
22510
22511Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22512address.
22513
22514This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22515The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22516of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22517equivalent is '::'.
22518
22519Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22520is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22521
22522This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22523family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22524
22525Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22526configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22527use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22528'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22529
22530Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22531socket type and the transport method.
22532
22533
2253411.1 Address family prefixes
22535----------------------------
22536
22537'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22538
22539'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22540 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22541 listening.
22542
22543'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22544 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22545 on the statement using this address, a port or
22546 a port range may or must be specified.
22547
22548'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22549 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22550 using this address, a port or a port range
22551 may or must be specified.
22552
22553'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22554 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22555 using this address, a port or a port range
22556 may or must be specified.
22557
22558'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22559 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22560 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22561 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22562 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22563 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22564
22565'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22566 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22567 start by slash '/'.
22568
22569
2257011.2 Socket type prefixes
22571-------------------------
22572
22573Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22574type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22575this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22576This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22577but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22578
22579Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22580instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22581
22582If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22583they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22584report this to the maintainers.
22585
22586'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22587 to "stream"
22588
22589'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22590 to "datagram".
22591
22592
2259311.3 Protocol prefixes
22594----------------------
22595
22596'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22597 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22598 socket type and transport method is forced to
22599 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22600 this address, a port or a port range can or
22601 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22602 of 'stream+ip@'.
22603
22604'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22605 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22606 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22607 statement using this address, a port or port
22608 range can or must be specified.
22609 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22610
22611'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22612 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22613 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22614 statement using this address, a port or port
22615 range can or must be specified.
22616 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22617
22618'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22619 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22620 socket type and transport method is forced to
22621 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22622 this address, a port or a port range can or
22623 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22624 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22625
22626'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22627 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22628 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22629 the statement using this address, a port or
22630 port range can or must be specified.
22631 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22632
22633'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22634 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22635 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22636 the statement using this address, a port or
22637 port range can or must be specified.
22638 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22639
22640'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22641 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22642 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22643
22644'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22645 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22646 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22647
22648In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22649QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022651/*
22652 * Local variables:
22653 * fill-column: 79
22654 * End:
22655 */